blob: efcd8e32972ed4fd11f29d02c76009cb1711928b [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file was developed by the LLVM research group and is distributed under
6// the University of Illinois Open Source License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG This pass is where algebraic
12// simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Duncan Sandsb84abcd2007-09-11 14:35:41 +000042#include "llvm/ParameterAttributes.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000048#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000049#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000050#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000051#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000052#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000053#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000054#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000059#include <algorithm>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000060#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000061using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000062using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000063
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000064STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
65STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
66STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
67STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
68STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000069
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000070namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000071 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
72 : public FunctionPass,
73 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000074 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000075 std::vector<Instruction*> Worklist;
76 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000077 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000078 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000079 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000080 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000081 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass((intptr_t)&ID) {}
82
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000083 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
84 /// isn't already in it.
85 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
86 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())))
87 Worklist.push_back(I);
88 }
89
90 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
91 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
92 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
93 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
94
95 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
96 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
97
98 WorklistMap.erase(It);
99 }
100
101 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
102 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
103 Worklist.pop_back();
104 WorklistMap.erase(I);
105 return I;
106 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000107
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000108
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000109 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
110 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
111 /// now.
112 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000113 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000114 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000115 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000116 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 }
118
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000119 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
120 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
121 ///
122 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
123 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
124 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i)))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000125 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000126 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000127
128 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
129 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
130 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
131 ///
132 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
133 ///
134 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
135 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
136
137 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
138 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000139 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000140 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
141 I.setOperand(i, UndefValue::get(Op->getType()));
142 }
143
144 return R;
145 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000146
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000147 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000148 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000149
150 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000151
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000152 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000153 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000154 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000155 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000156 }
157
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000158 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
159
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000160 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
161 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
162 // Return Value:
163 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000164 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000165 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000166 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000167 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
168 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
169 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000170 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
172 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000175 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
176 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
178 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000180 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000183 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
186 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000187 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
188 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
189 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000190 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
191 Instruction *LHS,
192 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000193 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
194 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000195
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000196 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
197 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000198 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000199 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000200 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
201 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000202 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000203 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
204 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
205 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000206 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI);
207 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
208 Instruction *visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI);
210 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
211 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
212 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
213 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000214 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000215 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
216 Instruction *FI);
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +0000217 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &CI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000218 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
219 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000220 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
221 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000222 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000223 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000224 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000225 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000226 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000227 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000228 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000229 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000230 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000231
232 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000233 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000234
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000235 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000236 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000237 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000238 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000239
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000240 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000241 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
242 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
243 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000244 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000245 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
246 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000247 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
248 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000249 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000250 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000251 }
252
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000253 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
254 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
255 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000256 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
257 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000258 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000259
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000260 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000261 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000262
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000263 Instruction *C = CastInst::create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000264 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000265 return C;
266 }
267
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000268 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
269 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
270 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
271 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
272 // modified.
273 //
274 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000275 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000276 if (&I != V) {
277 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
278 return &I;
279 } else {
280 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
281 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000282 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000283 return &I;
284 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000285 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000286
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000287 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
288 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
289 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
290 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
291 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
292 //
293 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
294 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
295 if (Old != New)
296 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
297 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000298 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000299 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000300 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000301 return true;
302 }
303
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000304 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
305 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
306 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
307 // this function.
308 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
309 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
310 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000311 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000312 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000313 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
314 }
315
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000316 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000317 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
318 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
319 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
320 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000321 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
322 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000323 Instruction *InsertBefore);
324
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000325 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
326 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000327 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000328
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000329 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
330 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
331 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
332
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000333 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
334 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000335 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
336 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
337 unsigned Depth = 0);
338
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000339 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
340 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
341
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000342 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
343 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
344 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
345 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
346
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000347 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
348 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
349 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
350 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000351 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
352
353
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000354 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
355 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000356
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000357 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000358 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000359 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000360 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000361 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000362 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000363 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000364
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000365 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000366 };
Chris Lattnerf6293092002-07-23 18:06:35 +0000367
Devang Patel19974732007-05-03 01:11:54 +0000368 char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
Chris Lattner7f8897f2006-08-27 22:42:52 +0000369 RegisterPass<InstCombiner> X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000370}
371
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000372// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000373// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000374static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
375 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
376 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000377 return 3;
378 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000379 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000380 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
381 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000382}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000383
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000384// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
385// it.
386static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000387 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000388}
389
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000390// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
391// though a va_arg area...
392static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000393 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
394 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
395 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000396 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000397 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000398}
399
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000400/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst or a constant
401/// expression bitcast, return the operand value, otherwise return null.
402static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
403 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000404 return I->getOperand(0);
405 else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000406 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000407 return CE->getOperand(0);
408 return 0;
409}
410
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000411/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
412/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000413static Instruction::CastOps
414isEliminableCastPair(
415 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
416 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
417 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
418 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
419) {
420
421 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
422 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000423
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000424 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
425 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
426 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000427
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000428 return Instruction::CastOps(
429 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
430 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000431}
432
433/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
434/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
435/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000436static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
437 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000438 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
439
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000440 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000441 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000442 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000443 return false;
444 return true;
445}
446
447/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
448/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
449/// casts that are known to not do anything...
450///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000451Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
452 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000453 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
454 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
455 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000456 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000457
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000458 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000461// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
462// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000463//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000464// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
465// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
466// binary operators.
467//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000468// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
469// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000470//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000471bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000472 bool Changed = false;
473 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
474 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000475
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000476 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
477 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000478 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
479 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
480 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000481 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
482 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
483 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000484 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
485 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
486 return true;
487 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
488 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
489 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
490 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
491 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
492
493 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000494 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000495 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
496 Op1->getOperand(0),
497 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000498 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000499 I.setOperand(0, New);
500 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
501 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000502 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000503 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000504 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000505}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000506
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000507/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
508/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
509/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
510bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
511 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
512 return false;
513 I.swapOperands();
514 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
515 return true;
516}
517
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000518// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
519// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000520//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000521static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
522 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000523 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000524
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000525 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
526 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
527 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000528 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000529}
530
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000531static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
532 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000533 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000534
535 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000536 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000537 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000538 return 0;
539}
540
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000541// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
542// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000543// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
544// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000545//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000546static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000547 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000548 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000549 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000550 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000551 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000552 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000553 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000554 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000555 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000556 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000557 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000558 return I->getOperand(0);
559 }
560 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000561 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000562}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000563
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000564/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
565/// expression, return it.
566static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
567 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
568 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
569 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
570 return cast<User>(V);
571 return false;
572}
573
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000574/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000575static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000576 APInt Val(C->getValue());
577 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000578}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000579/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000580static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000581 APInt Val(C->getValue());
582 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000583}
584/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
585static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
586 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
587}
588/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
589static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
590 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
591}
592/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
593static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
594 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
595}
596/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
597static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
598 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000599}
600
Chris Lattner68d5ff22006-02-09 07:38:58 +0000601/// ComputeMaskedBits - Determine which of the bits specified in Mask are
602/// known to be either zero or one and return them in the KnownZero/KnownOne
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000603/// bit sets. This code only analyzes bits in Mask, in order to short-circuit
604/// processing.
605/// NOTE: we cannot consider 'undef' to be "IsZero" here. The problem is that
606/// we cannot optimize based on the assumption that it is zero without changing
607/// it to be an explicit zero. If we don't change it to zero, other code could
608/// optimized based on the contradictory assumption that it is non-zero.
609/// Because instcombine aggressively folds operations with undef args anyway,
610/// this won't lose us code quality.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +0000611static void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt& KnownZero,
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000612 APInt& KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000613 assert(V && "No Value?");
614 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000615 uint32_t BitWidth = Mask.getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000616 assert(cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000617 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000618 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000619 "V, Mask, KnownOne and KnownZero should have same BitWidth");
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000620 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
621 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000622 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & Mask;
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000623 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & Mask;
624 return;
625 }
626
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000627 if (Depth == 6 || Mask == 0)
628 return; // Limit search depth.
629
630 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
631 if (!I) return;
632
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000633 KnownZero.clear(); KnownOne.clear(); // Don't know anything.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000634 APInt KnownZero2(KnownZero), KnownOne2(KnownOne);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000635
636 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000637 case Instruction::And: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000638 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
639 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000640 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownZero);
641 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000642 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
643 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
644
645 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
646 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
647 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
648 KnownZero |= KnownZero2;
649 return;
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000650 }
651 case Instruction::Or: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000652 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000653 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownOne);
654 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000655 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
656 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
657
658 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
659 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
660 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
661 KnownOne |= KnownOne2;
662 return;
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000663 }
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000664 case Instruction::Xor: {
665 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
666 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
667 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
668 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
669
670 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
671 APInt KnownZeroOut = (KnownZero & KnownZero2) | (KnownOne & KnownOne2);
672 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
673 KnownOne = (KnownZero & KnownOne2) | (KnownOne & KnownZero2);
674 KnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
675 return;
676 }
677 case Instruction::Select:
678 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(2), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
679 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
680 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
681 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
682
683 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
684 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
685 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
686 return;
687 case Instruction::FPTrunc:
688 case Instruction::FPExt:
689 case Instruction::FPToUI:
690 case Instruction::FPToSI:
691 case Instruction::SIToFP:
692 case Instruction::PtrToInt:
693 case Instruction::UIToFP:
694 case Instruction::IntToPtr:
695 return; // Can't work with floating point or pointers
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000696 case Instruction::Trunc: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000697 // All these have integer operands
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000698 uint32_t SrcBitWidth =
699 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000700 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
701 MaskIn.zext(SrcBitWidth);
702 KnownZero.zext(SrcBitWidth);
703 KnownOne.zext(SrcBitWidth);
704 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000705 KnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
706 KnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000707 return;
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000708 }
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000709 case Instruction::BitCast: {
710 const Type *SrcTy = I->getOperand(0)->getType();
711 if (SrcTy->isInteger()) {
712 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
713 return;
714 }
715 break;
716 }
717 case Instruction::ZExt: {
718 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
719 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000720 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000721
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000722 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
723 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
724 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
725 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
726 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000727 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
728 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000729 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
730 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000731 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000732 return;
733 }
734 case Instruction::SExt: {
735 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
736 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000737 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000738
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000739 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
740 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
741 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
742 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
743 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000744 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000745 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
746 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000747
748 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
749 // top bits of the result.
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000750 if (KnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known zero
Zhou Sheng34a4b382007-03-28 17:38:21 +0000751 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000752 else if (KnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known set
Zhou Sheng34a4b382007-03-28 17:38:21 +0000753 KnownOne |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000754 return;
755 }
756 case Instruction::Shl:
757 // (shl X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (X & C2 >>u C1) == 0
758 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000759 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000760 APInt Mask2(Mask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
761 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000762 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Sheng430f6262007-03-12 05:44:52 +0000763 KnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
764 KnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000765 KnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt); // low bits known 0
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000766 return;
767 }
768 break;
769 case Instruction::LShr:
770 // (ushr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
771 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
772 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000773 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000774
775 // Unsigned shift right.
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000776 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
777 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000778 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
779 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
780 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000781 // high bits known zero.
782 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000783 return;
784 }
785 break;
786 case Instruction::AShr:
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000787 // (ashr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000788 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
789 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000790 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000791
792 // Signed shift right.
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000793 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
794 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000795 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
796 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
797 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
798
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000799 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
800 if (KnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known zero.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000801 KnownZero |= HighBits;
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000802 else if (KnownOne[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known one.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000803 KnownOne |= HighBits;
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000804 return;
805 }
806 break;
807 }
808}
809
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000810/// MaskedValueIsZero - Return true if 'V & Mask' is known to be zero. We use
811/// this predicate to simplify operations downstream. Mask is known to be zero
812/// for bits that V cannot have.
813static bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt& Mask, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Shengedd089c2007-03-12 16:54:56 +0000814 APInt KnownZero(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0), KnownOne(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0);
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000815 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
816 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
817 return (KnownZero & Mask) == Mask;
818}
819
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000820/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
821/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
822/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
823/// constant and return true.
824static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000825 APInt Demanded) {
826 assert(I && "No instruction?");
827 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
828
829 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
830 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
831 if (!OpC) return false;
832
833 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
834 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
835 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
836 return false;
837
838 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
839 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
840 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
841 return true;
842}
843
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000844// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
845// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
846// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
847// min/max.
848static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000849 const APInt& KnownZero,
850 const APInt& KnownOne,
851 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
852 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
853 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
854 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
855 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
856 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000857 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000858
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000859 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
860 // bit if it is unknown.
861 Min = KnownOne;
862 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
863
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000864 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000865 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
866 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000867 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000868}
869
870// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
871// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
872// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
873// min/max.
874static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000875 const APInt &KnownZero,
876 const APInt &KnownOne,
877 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
878 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000879 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
880 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
881 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
882 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000883 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000884
885 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
886 Min = KnownOne;
887 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
888 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
889}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000890
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000891/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
892/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
893/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
894/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
895/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
896/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
897/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
898/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
899/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
900/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
901/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
902/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
903/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
904/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
905/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
906bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
907 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
908 unsigned Depth) {
909 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
910 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
911 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
912 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
913 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
914 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
915 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
916 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
917 must have same BitWidth");
918 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
919 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
920 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
921 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
922 return false;
923 }
924
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000925 KnownZero.clear();
926 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000927 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
928 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
929 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
930 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
931 return false;
932 }
933 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
934 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
935 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
936 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
937 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
938 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
939 return false;
940 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
941 return false;
942 }
943
944 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
945 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
946
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000947 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
948 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
949 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
950 default: break;
951 case Instruction::And:
952 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
953 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
954 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
955 return true;
956 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
957 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
958
959 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
960 // LHS.
961 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
962 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
963 return true;
964 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
965 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
966
967 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
968 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
969 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
970 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
971 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
972 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
973 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
974 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
975
976 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
977 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
978 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
979
980 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
981 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
982 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
983
984 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
985 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
986 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
987 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
988 break;
989 case Instruction::Or:
990 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
991 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
992 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
993 return true;
994 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
995 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
996 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
997 // LHS.
998 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
999 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1000 return true;
1001 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1002 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1003
1004 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1005 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
1006 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
1007 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
1008 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1009 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
1010 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
1011 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1012
1013 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
1014 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
1015 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
1016 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
1017 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1018 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
1019 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
1020 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1021
1022 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1023 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1024 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1025
1026 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
1027 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1028 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
1029 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
1030 break;
1031 case Instruction::Xor: {
1032 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1033 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1034 return true;
1035 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1036 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1037 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1038 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1039 return true;
1040 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1041 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1042
1043 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1044 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
1045 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1046 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1047 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1048 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1049
1050 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
1051 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
1052 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
1053 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
1054 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
1055 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
1056
1057 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
1058 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
1059 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
1060 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
1061 Instruction *Or =
1062 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1063 I->getName());
1064 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1065 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1066 }
1067
1068 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
1069 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
1070 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
1071 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
1072 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
1073 // all known
1074 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
1075 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
1076 Instruction *And =
1077 BinaryOperator::createAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
1078 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
1079 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
1080 }
1081 }
1082
1083 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1084 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
1085 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1086 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1087
1088 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
1089 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
1090 break;
1091 }
1092 case Instruction::Select:
1093 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
1094 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1095 return true;
1096 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1097 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1098 return true;
1099 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1100 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1101 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1102 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1103
1104 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
1105 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1106 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1107 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
1108 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1109
1110 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1111 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
1112 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1113 break;
1114 case Instruction::Trunc: {
1115 uint32_t truncBf =
1116 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001117 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
1118 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1119 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
1120 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1121 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001122 return true;
1123 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1124 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1125 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1126 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1127 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1128 break;
1129 }
1130 case Instruction::BitCast:
1131 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1132 return false;
1133
1134 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1135 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1136 return true;
1137 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1138 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1139 break;
1140 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1141 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1142 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001143 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001144
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001145 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1146 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1147 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001148 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1149 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001150 return true;
1151 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1152 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1153 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1154 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1155 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1156 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001157 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001158 break;
1159 }
1160 case Instruction::SExt: {
1161 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1162 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001163 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001164
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001165 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001166 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001167
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001168 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001169 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1170 // bit is demanded.
1171 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001172 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001173
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001174 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1175 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1176 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001177 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1178 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001179 return true;
1180 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1181 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1182 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1183 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1184 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1185
1186 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1187 // top bits of the result.
1188
1189 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1190 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001191 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001192 {
1193 // Convert to ZExt cast
1194 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1195 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001196 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001197 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001198 }
1199 break;
1200 }
1201 case Instruction::Add: {
1202 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1203 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1204 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001205 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001206
1207 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1208 // we can do.
1209 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1210 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1211 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1212 if (RHS->isZero())
1213 break;
1214
1215 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1216 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001217 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001218
1219 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1220 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1221 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1222 return true;
1223
1224 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1225 // the constant.
1226 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1227 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1228
1229 // Avoid excess work.
1230 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1231 break;
1232
1233 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1234 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1235 Instruction *Or =
1236 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1237 I->getName());
1238 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1239 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1240 }
1241
1242 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1243 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1244 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1245 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1246 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1247
1248 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1249 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1250 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001251 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1252 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001253
1254 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1255
1256 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1257 // other, and there is no input carry.
1258 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1259 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1260
1261 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1262 // is no input carry.
1263 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1264 } else {
1265 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1266 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001267 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001268 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1269 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001270 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001271 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1272 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1273 return true;
1274 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1275 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1276 return true;
1277 }
1278 }
1279 break;
1280 }
1281 case Instruction::Sub:
1282 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1283 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001284 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001285 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1286 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001287 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001288 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001289 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1290 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1291 return true;
1292 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1293 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1294 return true;
1295 }
1296 break;
1297 case Instruction::Shl:
1298 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001299 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001300 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1301 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001302 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1303 return true;
1304 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1305 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1306 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1307 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1308 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001309 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001310 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001311 }
1312 break;
1313 case Instruction::LShr:
1314 // For a logical shift right
1315 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001316 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001317
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001318 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001319 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1320 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001321 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1322 return true;
1323 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1324 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001325 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1326 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001327 if (ShiftAmt) {
1328 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001329 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001330 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1331 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001332 }
1333 break;
1334 case Instruction::AShr:
1335 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1336 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1337 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1338 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1339 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1340 // Perform the logical shift right.
1341 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1342 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1343 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1344 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1345 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001346
1347 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1348 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1349 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1350 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001351
1352 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001353 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001354
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001355 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001356 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001357 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1358 // demanded.
1359 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1360 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001361 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001362 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001363 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1364 return true;
1365 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1366 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1367 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001368 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001369 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1370 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1371
1372 // Handle the sign bits.
1373 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1374 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1375 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1376
1377 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1378 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001379 if (RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001380 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1381 // Perform the logical shift right.
1382 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1383 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1384 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1385 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1386 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1387 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1388 }
1389 }
1390 break;
1391 }
1392
1393 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1394 // constant.
1395 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1396 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1397 return false;
1398}
1399
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001400
1401/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1402/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1403/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1404/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1405///
1406/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1407/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1408/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1409Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1410 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1411 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001412 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001413 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1414 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
1415 assert(DemandedElts != EltMask && (DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 &&
1416 "Invalid DemandedElts!");
1417
1418 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1419 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1420 UndefElts = EltMask;
1421 return 0;
1422 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1423 UndefElts = EltMask;
1424 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1425 }
1426
1427 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001428 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1429 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001430 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1431
1432 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1433 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1434 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1435 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1436 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1437 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1438 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1439 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1440 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1441 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1442 }
1443
1444 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001445 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001446 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1447 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001448 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001449 // set to undef.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001450 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001451 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1452 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1453 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1454 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1455 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1456 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001457 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001458 }
1459
1460 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
1461 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
1462 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1463 return false;
1464 }
1465 return false;
1466 } else if (Depth == 10) { // Limit search depth.
1467 return false;
1468 }
1469
1470 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1471 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1472
1473 bool MadeChange = false;
1474 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1475 Value *TmpV;
1476 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1477 default: break;
1478
1479 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1480 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1481 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001482 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001483 if (Idx == 0) {
1484 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1485 // which elt is getting updated.
1486 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1487 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1488 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1489 break;
1490 }
1491
1492 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1493 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001494 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001495 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1496 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1497
1498 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1499 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1500 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1501 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1502 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1503 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1504
1505 // The inserted element is defined.
1506 UndefElts |= 1ULL << IdxNo;
1507 break;
1508 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001509 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001510 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001511 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1512 if (!VTy) break;
1513 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1514 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1515 unsigned Ratio;
1516
1517 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001518 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001519 // elements as are demanded of us.
1520 Ratio = 1;
1521 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1522 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1523 // Untested so far.
1524 break;
1525
1526 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1527 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1528 // elements are live.
1529 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1530 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1531 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1532 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1533 }
1534 } else {
1535 // Untested so far.
1536 break;
1537
1538 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1539 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1540 // live.
1541 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1542 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1543 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1544 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1545 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001546
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001547 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1548 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1549 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1550 if (TmpV) {
1551 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1552 MadeChange = true;
1553 }
1554
1555 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1556 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1557 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1558 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1559 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1560 // undef.
1561 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1562 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1563 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1564 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1565 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1566 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1567 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1568 // elements are undef.
1569 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1570 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1571 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1572 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1573 }
1574 break;
1575 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001576 case Instruction::And:
1577 case Instruction::Or:
1578 case Instruction::Xor:
1579 case Instruction::Add:
1580 case Instruction::Sub:
1581 case Instruction::Mul:
1582 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1583 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1584 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1585 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1586 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1587 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1588 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1589
1590 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1591 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1592 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1593 break;
1594
1595 case Instruction::Call: {
1596 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1597 if (!II) break;
1598 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1599 default: break;
1600
1601 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1602 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1603 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1604 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1605 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1606 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1607 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1608 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1609 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1610 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1611 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1612 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1613 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1614 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1615 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1616 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1617
1618 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1619 // scalarize it now.
1620 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1621 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1622 default: break;
1623 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1624 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1625 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1626 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1627 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1628 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1629 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1630 // Extract the element as scalars.
1631 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1632 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1633
1634 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1635 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1636 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1637 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1638 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, RHS,
1639 II->getName()), *II);
1640 break;
1641 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1642 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1643 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, RHS,
1644 II->getName()), *II);
1645 break;
1646 }
1647
1648 Instruction *New =
1649 new InsertElementInst(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1650 II->getName());
1651 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1652 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1653 return New;
1654 }
1655 }
1656
1657 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1658 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1659 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1660 break;
1661 }
1662 break;
1663 }
1664 }
1665 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1666}
1667
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00001668/// @returns true if the specified compare predicate is
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001669/// true when both operands are equal...
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00001670/// @brief Determine if the icmp Predicate is true when both operands are equal
1671static bool isTrueWhenEqual(ICmpInst::Predicate pred) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001672 return pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
1673 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
1674 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
1675}
1676
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00001677/// @returns true if the specified compare instruction is
1678/// true when both operands are equal...
1679/// @brief Determine if the ICmpInst returns true when both operands are equal
1680static bool isTrueWhenEqual(ICmpInst &ICI) {
1681 return isTrueWhenEqual(ICI.getPredicate());
1682}
1683
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001684/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1685/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1686/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1687/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1688/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1689/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1690/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1691///
1692template<typename Functor>
1693Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
1694 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1695 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1696
1697 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1698 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1699 return F.apply(Root);
1700
1701 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1702 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001703 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001704 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1705 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1706
1707 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1708 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1709 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1710 ShouldApply = true;
1711 }
1712
1713 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1714 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1715 if (ShouldApply) {
1716 BasicBlock *BB = Root.getParent();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001717
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001718 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1719 // and perform the reassociation.
1720 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1721
1722 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1723 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1724
1725 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1726 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001727 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001728 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1729 return 0;
1730 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001731 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001732 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001733 TmpLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(TmpLHSI);
1734 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
1735 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, TmpLHSI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
1736 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001737
1738 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1739 // get to LHSI.
1740 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1741 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001742 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1743 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
1744 NextLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(NextLHSI);
1745 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, NextLHSI);
1746 ARI = NextLHSI;
1747
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001748 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1749 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1750 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1751 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1752 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001753
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001754 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1755 // the transformation...
1756 return F.apply(Root);
1757 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001758
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001759 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1760 }
1761 return 0;
1762}
1763
1764
1765// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
1766struct AddRHS {
1767 Value *RHS;
1768 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1769 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1770 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00001771 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Add.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00001772 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001773 }
1774};
1775
1776// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1777// iff C1&C2 == 0
1778struct AddMaskingAnd {
1779 Constant *C2;
1780 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1781 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001782 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001783 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001784 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001785 }
1786 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001787 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001788 }
1789};
1790
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001791static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001792 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001793 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001794 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001795 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001796
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001797 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::create(
1798 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001799 }
1800
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001801 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001802 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1803 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001804
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001805 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1806 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001807 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1808 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001809 }
1810
1811 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1812 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1813 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1814 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001815 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1816 New = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001817 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1818 New = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
1819 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001820 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001821 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001822 abort();
1823 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001824 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1825}
1826
1827// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1828// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1829// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1830// not have a second operand.
1831static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1832 InstCombiner *IC) {
1833 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1834 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1835 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1836 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1837
1838 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001839 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001840 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001841
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001842 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1843 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1844
1845 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1846 SelectFalseVal);
1847 }
1848 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001849}
1850
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001851
1852/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1853/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1854/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1855Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1856 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001857 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001858 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001859
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001860 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1861 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001862 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001863 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1864 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1865 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1866 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001867 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001868 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1869
1870 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1871 // loop.
1872 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1873 return 0;
1874 }
1875
1876 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1877 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1878 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1879 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1880 if (NonConstBB) {
1881 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1882 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1883 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001884
1885 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001886 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001887 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001888 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001889 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001890
1891 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1892 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1893 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001894 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001895 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001896 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001897 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1898 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1899 else
1900 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001901 } else {
1902 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1903 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1904 InV = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(),
1905 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1906 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001907 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1908 InV = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(),
1909 CI->getPredicate(),
1910 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1911 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001912 else
1913 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1914
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001915 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001916 }
1917 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001918 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001919 } else {
1920 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1921 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001922 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001923 Value *InV;
1924 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001925 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001926 } else {
1927 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001928 InV = CastInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
1929 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1930 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001931 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001932 }
1933 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001934 }
1935 }
1936 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1937}
1938
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001939Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001940 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001941 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001942
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001943 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001944 // X + undef -> undef
1945 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1946 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1947
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001948 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001949 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001950 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1951 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001952 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00001953 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
1954 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001955 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001956 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001957
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001958 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001959 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001960 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001961 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001962 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001963 return BinaryOperator::createXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001964
1965 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
1966 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001967 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
1968 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
1969 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
1970 KnownZero, KnownOne))
1971 return &I;
1972 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001973 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001974
1975 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
1976 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1977 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001978
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001979 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
1980 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00001981 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
1982 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001983 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001984 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001985
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001986 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001987 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
1988 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001989 do {
1990 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001991 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
1992 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001993 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
1994 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001995 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00001996 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
1997 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001998 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001999 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002000 }
2001 }
2002 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002003 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2004 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2005 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002006
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002007 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
2008 // with funny bit widths then this whole cascade of if statements should
2009 // be removed. It is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back
2010 // up to something that the back ends can handle.
2011 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2012 switch (Size) {
2013 default: break;
2014 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2015 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2016 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2017 }
2018 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002019 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002020 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002021 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002022 }
2023 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002024 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002025
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002026 // X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002027 if (I.getType()->isInteger() && I.getType() != Type::Int1Ty) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002028 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002029
2030 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2031 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2032 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2033 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2034 }
2035 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2036 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2037 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2038 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2039 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002040 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002041
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002042 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002043 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(LHS))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002044 return BinaryOperator::createSub(RHS, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002045
2046 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002047 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2048 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002049 return BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002050
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002051
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002052 ConstantInt *C2;
2053 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2054 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
2055 return BinaryOperator::createMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
2056
2057 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2058 ConstantInt *C1;
2059 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002060 return BinaryOperator::createMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002061 }
2062
2063 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002064 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
2065 return BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
2066
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002067 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002068 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2069 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002070
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002071
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002072 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002073 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002074 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2075 return R;
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002076
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002077 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002078 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002079 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
2080 return BinaryOperator::createSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002081
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002082 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2083 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002084 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002085 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2086 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2087 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002088 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002089
2090 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002091 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002092
2093 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002094 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002095
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002096 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2097 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
2098 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, CRHS,
2099 LHS->getName()), I);
2100 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewAdd, C2);
2101 }
2102 }
2103 }
2104
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002105 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2106 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002107 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002108 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002109 }
2110
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002111 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
2112 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) ->
2113 // intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002114 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002115 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2116 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002117 if (!CI) {
2118 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2119 Other = LHS;
2120 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002121 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002122 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2123 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002124 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002125 Value *I2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, CI->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002126 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty), I);
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002127 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new GetElementPtrInst(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002128 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002129 }
2130 }
2131
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002132 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002133}
2134
Chris Lattner1ba5bcd2003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002135// isSignBit - Return true if the value represented by the constant only has the
2136// highest order bit set.
2137static bool isSignBit(ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002138 uint32_t NumBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer5a1e3e12007-03-19 20:58:18 +00002139 return CI->getValue() == APInt::getSignBit(NumBits);
Chris Lattner1ba5bcd2003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002140}
2141
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002142Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002143 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002144
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002145 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
2146 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002147
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002148 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002149 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002150 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002151
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002152 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2153 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2154 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2155 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2156
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002157 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2158 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002159 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
2160 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002161
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002162 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002163 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002164 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002165 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, AddOne(C));
2166
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002167 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2168 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002169 if (C->isZero()) {
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002170 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1))
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002171 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002172 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002173 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002174 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002175 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002176 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002177 return BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr,
2178 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002179 }
2180 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002181 }
2182 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2183 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2184 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002185 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002186 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002187 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002188 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002189 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002190 }
2191 }
2192 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002193 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002194
2195 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2196 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002197 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002198 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002199
2200 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2201 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2202 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002203 }
2204
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002205 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2206 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002207 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002208 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002209 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002210 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002211 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002212 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2213 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2214 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002215 return BinaryOperator::createSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002216 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2217 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002218 }
2219
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002220 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002221 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2222 // is not used by anyone else...
2223 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002224 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002225 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002226 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2227 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2228 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2229 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002230
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002231 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002232 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002233 }
2234
2235 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2236 //
2237 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2238 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2239 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2240
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002241 Value *NewNot =
2242 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002243 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002244 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002245
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002246 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002247 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002248 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002249 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002250 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002251 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002252 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2253
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002254 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002255 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002256 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002257 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002258 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002259 }
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002260
2261 // X - ((X / Y) * Y) --> X % Y
2262 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
2263 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1I->getOperand(0)))
2264 if (Op0 == I->getOperand(0) &&
2265 Op1I->getOperand(1) == I->getOperand(1)) {
2266 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
2267 return BinaryOperator::createSRem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
2268 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
2269 return BinaryOperator::createURem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
2270 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002271 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002272 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002273
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002274 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002275 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2276 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002277 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2278 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2279 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2280 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002281 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2282 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
2283 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002284 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002285
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002286 ConstantInt *C1;
2287 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002288 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
2289 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002290
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002291 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2292 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002293 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002294 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002295 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002296}
2297
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002298/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2299/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2300/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2301/// signed.
2302static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2303 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002304 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002305 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2306 TrueIfSigned = true;
2307 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002308 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2309 TrueIfSigned = true;
2310 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002311 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2312 TrueIfSigned = false;
2313 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002314 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2315 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2316 TrueIfSigned = true;
2317 return RHS->getValue() ==
2318 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2319 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2320 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2321 TrueIfSigned = true;
2322 return RHS->getValue() ==
2323 APInt::getSignBit(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002324 default:
2325 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002326 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002327}
2328
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002329Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002330 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002331 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002332
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002333 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2334 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2335
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002336 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002337 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2338 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002339
2340 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002341 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002342 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2343 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002344 return BinaryOperator::createMul(SI->getOperand(0),
2345 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002346
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002347 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002348 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2349 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2350 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2351 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Chris Lattner0af1fab2003-06-25 17:09:20 +00002352 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002353
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002354 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002355 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002356 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002357 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002358 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002359 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002360 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2361 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002362
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002363 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2364 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00002365 // We need a better interface for long double here.
2366 if (Op1->getType() == Type::FloatTy || Op1->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
2367 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2368 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002369 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002370
2371 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2372 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
2373 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
2374 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
2375 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
2376 Op1, "tmp");
2377 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2378 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2379 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
2380 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Add, C1C2);
2381
2382 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002383
2384 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2385 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002386 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002387 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002388
2389 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2390 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2391 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002392 }
2393
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002394 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2395 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002396 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002397
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002398 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2399 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2400 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2401 // formed.
2402 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002403 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002404 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002405 BoolCast = CI;
2406 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002407 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002408 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002409 BoolCast = CI;
2410 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002411 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002412 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2413 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002414 bool TIS = false;
2415
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002416 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002417 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2418 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002419 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2420 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002421 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002422 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002423 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002424 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002425 InsertNewInstBefore(
2426 BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002427 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2428 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002429
2430 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2431 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002432 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002433 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2434 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002435 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2436 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2437 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2438 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2439 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002440
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002441 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002442 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002443 }
2444 }
2445 }
2446
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002447 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002448}
2449
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002450/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2451/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2452/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2453/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002454Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002455 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002456
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002457 // undef / X -> 0
2458 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002459 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002460
2461 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002462 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002463 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002464
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002465 // Handle cases involving: div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002466 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2467 // div X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div X, Y. If the div and the select are in the
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002468 // same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the condition
2469 // of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same BB). If the
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002470 // select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be simplified
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002471 // also. Note that div X, Y is just as good as div X, 0 (undef)
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002472 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2473 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2474 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2475 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002476 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002477 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2478 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2479 else
2480 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
2481 return &I;
2482 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002483
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002484 // Likewise for: div X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div X, Y
2485 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2486 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2487 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2488 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002489 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002490 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2491 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2492 else
2493 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2494 return &I;
2495 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002496 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002497
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002498 return 0;
2499}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002500
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002501/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2502/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2503/// division instructions.
2504/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002505Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002506 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2507
2508 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2509 return Common;
2510
2511 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2512 // div X, 1 == X
2513 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2514 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2515
2516 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2517 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2518 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2519 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
2520 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002521 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002522 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002523
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002524 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002525 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2526 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2527 return R;
2528 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2529 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2530 return NV;
2531 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002532 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002533
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002534 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002535 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002536 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2537 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2538
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002539 return 0;
2540}
2541
2542Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2543 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2544
2545 // Handle the integer div common cases
2546 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2547 return Common;
2548
2549 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2550 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2551 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2552 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002553 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002554 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002555 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002556 }
2557
2558 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002559 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002560 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2561 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002562 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002563 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002564 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002565 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002566 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002567 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
2568 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002569 }
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002570 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002571 }
2572 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002573 }
2574
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002575 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2576 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002577 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002578 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002579 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002580 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002581 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002582 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002583 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002584 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2585 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
2586 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2587 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2588 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2589
2590 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2591 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
2592 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2593 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2594 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002595
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002596 // construct the select instruction and return it.
2597 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002598 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002599 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002600 return 0;
2601}
2602
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002603Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2604 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2605
2606 // Handle the integer div common cases
2607 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2608 return Common;
2609
2610 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2611 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2612 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
2613 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0);
2614
2615 // -X/C -> X/-C
2616 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
2617 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
2618 }
2619
2620 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2621 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002622 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002623 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002624 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002625 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002626 return BinaryOperator::createUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2627 }
2628 }
2629
2630 return 0;
2631}
2632
2633Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2634 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2635}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002636
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002637/// GetFactor - If we can prove that the specified value is at least a multiple
2638/// of some factor, return that factor.
2639static Constant *GetFactor(Value *V) {
2640 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
2641 return CI;
2642
2643 // Unless we can be tricky, we know this is a multiple of 1.
2644 Constant *Result = ConstantInt::get(V->getType(), 1);
2645
2646 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
2647 if (!I) return Result;
2648
2649 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
2650 // Handle multiplies by a constant, etc.
2651 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)),
2652 GetFactor(I->getOperand(1)));
2653 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
2654 // (X<<C) -> X * (1 << C)
2655 if (Constant *ShRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2656 ShRHS = ConstantExpr::getShl(Result, ShRHS);
2657 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)), ShRHS);
2658 }
2659 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
2660 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2661 // X & 0xFFF0 is known to be a multiple of 16.
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00002662 uint32_t Zeros = RHS->getValue().countTrailingZeros();
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002663 if (Zeros != V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
2664 return ConstantExpr::getShl(Result,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002665 ConstantInt::get(Result->getType(), Zeros));
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002666 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002667 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002668 // Only handle int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002669 if (!CI->isIntegerCast())
2670 return Result;
2671 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
2672 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), GetFactor(Op), V->getType());
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002673 }
2674 return Result;
2675}
2676
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002677/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2678/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2679/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2680/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2681Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002682 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002683
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002684 // 0 % X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
2685 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2686 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2687 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2688
2689 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) // undef % X -> 0
2690 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2691 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2692 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002693
2694 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2695 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2696 // rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> rem X, Y. If the rem and the select are in
2697 // the same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the
2698 // condition of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same
2699 // BB). If the select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be
2700 // simplified also.
2701 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2702 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2703 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2704 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002705 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002706 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2707 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2708 else
2709 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002710 return &I;
2711 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002712 // Likewise for: rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> rem X, Y
2713 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2714 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2715 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2716 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002717 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002718 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2719 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2720 else
2721 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2722 return &I;
2723 }
Chris Lattner11a49f22005-11-05 07:28:37 +00002724 }
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002725
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002726 return 0;
2727}
2728
2729/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2730/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2731/// remainder instructions.
2732/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2733Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2734 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2735
2736 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2737 return common;
2738
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002739 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002740 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2741 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2742 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2743
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002744 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2745 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2746
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002747 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2748 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2749 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2750 return R;
2751 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2752 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2753 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002754 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002755 // (X * C1) % C2 --> 0 iff C1 % C2 == 0
2756 if (ConstantExpr::getSRem(GetFactor(Op0I), RHS)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002757 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002758 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002759 }
2760
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002761 return 0;
2762}
2763
2764Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2765 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2766
2767 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2768 return common;
2769
2770 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2771 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2772 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2773 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2774 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002775 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002776 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
2777 }
2778
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002779 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002780 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2781 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2782 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002783 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002784 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
2785 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(RHSI, N1,
2786 "tmp"), I);
2787 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, Add);
2788 }
2789 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002790 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002791
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002792 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
2793 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2794 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2795 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2796 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
2797 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002798 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
2799 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002800 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2801 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
2802 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2803 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
2804 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
2805 }
2806 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002807 }
2808
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002809 return 0;
2810}
2811
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002812Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2813 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2814
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002815 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002816 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2817 return common;
2818
2819 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
2820 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) ||
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002821 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002822 // X % -Y -> X % Y
2823 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
2824 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
2825 return &I;
2826 }
2827
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002828 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002829 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002830 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
2831 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
2832 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2833 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
2834 return BinaryOperator::createURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2835 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002836 }
2837
2838 return 0;
2839}
2840
2841Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002842 return commonRemTransforms(I);
2843}
2844
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002845// isMaxValueMinusOne - return true if this is Max-1
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002846static bool isMaxValueMinusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Reid Spencer3a2a9fb2007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002847 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002848 if (!isSigned)
2849 return C->getValue() == APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits) - 1;
2850 return C->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(TypeBits)-1;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002851}
2852
2853// isMinValuePlusOne - return true if this is Min+1
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002854static bool isMinValuePlusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002855 if (!isSigned)
2856 return C->getValue() == 1; // unsigned
2857
2858 // Calculate 1111111111000000000000
2859 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2860 return C->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMinValue(TypeBits)+1;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002861}
2862
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002863// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
2864// constant.
2865static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00002866 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002867}
2868
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002869// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
2870// This is the same as lowones(~X).
2871static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00002872 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002873}
2874
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002875/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002876/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
2877///
2878/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
2879///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002880/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
2881/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002882///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002883/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
2884/// 0 A > B
2885/// 1 A == B
2886/// 2 A < B
2887///
2888/// <=> Value Definition
2889/// 000 0 Always false
2890/// 001 1 A > B
2891/// 010 2 A == B
2892/// 011 3 A >= B
2893/// 100 4 A < B
2894/// 101 5 A != B
2895/// 110 6 A <= B
2896/// 111 7 Always true
2897///
2898static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
2899 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002900 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002901 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
2902 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
2903 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
2904 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
2905 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
2906 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
2907 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
2908 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
2909 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
2910 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002911 // True -> 7
2912 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002913 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002914 return 0;
2915 }
2916}
2917
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002918/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
2919/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002920/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002921/// of predicate to use in new icmp instructions.
2922static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
2923 switch (code) {
2924 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002925 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002926 case 1:
2927 if (sign)
2928 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
2929 else
2930 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
2931 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
2932 case 3:
2933 if (sign)
2934 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
2935 else
2936 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
2937 case 4:
2938 if (sign)
2939 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
2940 else
2941 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
2942 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
2943 case 6:
2944 if (sign)
2945 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
2946 else
2947 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002948 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002949 }
2950}
2951
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002952static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
2953 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
2954 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
2955 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
2956 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
2957 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
2958}
2959
2960namespace {
2961// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
2962struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002963 InstCombiner &IC;
2964 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002965 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
2966 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
2967 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
2968 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002969 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002970 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
2971 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
2972 return (ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS ||
2973 ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002974 return false;
2975 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002976 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
2977 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
2978 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
2979 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
2980 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002981 }
2982
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002983 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002984 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002985 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002986 unsigned Code;
2987 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
2988 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
2989 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
2990 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00002991 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002992 }
2993
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002994 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
2995 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
2996
2997 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002998 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
2999 return I;
3000 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3001 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3002 }
3003};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003004} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003005
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003006// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3007// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003008// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003009Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003010 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3011 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003012 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3013 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003014 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003015 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003016 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003017
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003018 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3019 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003020 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003021 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003022 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003023 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003024 And->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003025 return BinaryOperator::createXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003026 }
3027 break;
3028 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003029 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3030 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003031
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003032 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3033 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003034 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003035 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003036 Or->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003037 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003038 }
3039 break;
3040 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003041 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003042 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3043 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3044 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003045 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003046
3047 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003048 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003049 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3050 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3051 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003052 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003053
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003054 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3055 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3056 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3057 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3058 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3059 // no effect.
3060 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3061 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3062 return &TheAnd;
3063 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003064 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003065 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003066 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003067 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003068 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003069 }
3070 }
3071 }
3072 }
3073 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003074
3075 case Instruction::Shl: {
3076 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3077 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3078 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003079 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003080 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003081 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3082 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003083
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003084 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3085 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003086 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3087 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003088 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3089 return &TheAnd;
3090 }
3091 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003092 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003093 case Instruction::LShr:
3094 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003095 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3096 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3097 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3098 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003099 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003100 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003101 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3102 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003103
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003104 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3105 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003106 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3107 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3108 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3109 return &TheAnd;
3110 }
3111 break;
3112 }
3113 case Instruction::AShr:
3114 // Signed shr.
3115 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3116 // with an and.
3117 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003118 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003119 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003120 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3121 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003122 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003123 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003124 // Make the argument unsigned.
3125 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003126 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00003127 BinaryOperator::createLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003128 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003129 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003130 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003131 }
3132 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003133 }
3134 return 0;
3135}
3136
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003137
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003138/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3139/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003140/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3141/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003142/// insert new instructions.
3143Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003144 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3145 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003146 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003147 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003148 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003149
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003150 if (Inside) {
3151 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003152 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003153
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003154 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003155 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003156 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003157 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3158 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3159 }
3160
3161 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3162 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
3163 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003164 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003165 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3166 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003167 }
3168
3169 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003170 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003171
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003172 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003173 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003174 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003175 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3176 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3177 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3178 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003179
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003180 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3181 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3182 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003183 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003184 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003185 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3186 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003187}
3188
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003189// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3190// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3191// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3192// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003193static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003194 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003195 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3196 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003197
3198 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003199 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003200 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003201 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003202 return true;
3203}
3204
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003205/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3206/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3207/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003208///
3209/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3210/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3211/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3212///
3213/// return (A +/- B).
3214///
3215Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003216 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003217 Instruction &I) {
3218 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3219 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3220 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3221
3222 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3223
3224 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3225 default: return 0;
3226 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003227 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003228 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003229 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3230 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3231 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003232 break;
3233
3234 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3235 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3236 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003237 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003238 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003239 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003240 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003241 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003242 break;
3243 }
3244 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003245 return 0;
3246 case Instruction::Or:
3247 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003248 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003249 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3250 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003251 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003252 break;
3253 return 0;
3254 }
3255
3256 Instruction *New;
3257 if (isSub)
3258 New = BinaryOperator::createSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3259 else
3260 New = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3261 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3262}
3263
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003264Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003265 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003266 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003267
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003268 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3269 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3270
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003271 // and X, X = X
3272 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003273 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003274
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003275 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003276 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003277 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003278 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3279 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3280 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003281 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003282 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003283 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003284 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003285 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003286 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003287 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3288 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003289 }
3290 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003291
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003292 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003293 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3294 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003295
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003296 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003297 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003298 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003299 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3300 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3301 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3302 case Instruction::Xor:
3303 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003304 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3305 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3306 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3307 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
3308 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
3309 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3310 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
3311 return BinaryOperator::create(
3312 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003313 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003314 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003315 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3316 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
3317 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
3318 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3319 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
3320 return BinaryOperator::create(
3321 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3322 }
3323 }
3324
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003325 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003326 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003327 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3328 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3329 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3330 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3331 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
3332 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3333 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003334 break;
3335
3336 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003337 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3338 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3339 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3340 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
3341 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003342 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003343 }
3344
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003345 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003346 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003347 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003348 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003349 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3350 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3351 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3352 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003353 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003354 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner7560c3a2006-02-08 07:34:50 +00003355 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003356 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3357 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003358 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3359 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3360 // other simplifications.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003361 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::createTruncOrBitCast(
3362 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3363 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003364 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003365 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003366 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003367 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003368 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewCast, C3);
3369 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3370 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3371 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003372 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003373 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3374 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3375 }
3376 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003377 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003378
3379 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3380 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003381 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003382 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003383 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3384 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3385 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003386 }
3387
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003388 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3389 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003390
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003391 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3392 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3393
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003394 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003395 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003396 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
3397 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003398 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003399 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Or);
3400 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003401
3402 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003403 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3404 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003405 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3406 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003407
3408 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3409 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3410 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
3411 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
3412 }
3413 }
3414
3415 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003416 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3417 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003418
3419 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3420 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3421 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
3422 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
3423 }
3424 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003425
3426 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3427 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3428 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3429 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3430 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3431 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3432 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3433 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3434 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3435 }
3436 }
3437 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3438 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3439 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3440 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3441 std::swap(A, B);
3442 }
3443 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
3444 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::createNot(B, "tmp");
3445 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
3446 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
3447 }
3448 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003449 }
3450
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003451 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3452 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3453 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003454 return R;
3455
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003456 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3457 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003458 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3459 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3460 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3461 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3462 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3463 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3464 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3465 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3466 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003467 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003468 ICmpInst::Predicate GT = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ?
3469 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3470 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3471 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003472 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003473 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3474 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3475 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3476 }
3477
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003478 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003479 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3480 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003481 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3482 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3483 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003484 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3485
3486 switch (LHSCC) {
3487 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003488 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003489 switch (RHSCC) {
3490 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003491 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3492 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3493 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003494 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003495 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3496 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3497 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003498 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3499 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003500 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003501 switch (RHSCC) {
3502 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003503 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3504 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3505 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3506 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3507 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3508 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3509 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3510 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3511 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3512 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3513 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003514 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003515 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3516 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003517 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3518 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3519 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3520 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattner424db022007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003521 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3522 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003523 }
3524 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3525 }
3526 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003527 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003528 switch (RHSCC) {
3529 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003530 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3531 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003532 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003533 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3534 break;
3535 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3536 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003537 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003538 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3539 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003540 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003541 break;
3542 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003543 switch (RHSCC) {
3544 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003545 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3546 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003547 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003548 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3549 break;
3550 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3551 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003552 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003553 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3554 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003555 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003556 break;
3557 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3558 switch (RHSCC) {
3559 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3560 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X > 13
3561 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3562 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3563 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3564 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3565 break;
3566 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3567 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3568 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3569 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3570 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3571 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3572 true, I);
3573 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3574 break;
3575 }
3576 break;
3577 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3578 switch (RHSCC) {
3579 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3580 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X s> 13
3581 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3582 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3583 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3584 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3585 break;
3586 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3587 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3588 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3589 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3590 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3591 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3592 true, I);
3593 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3594 break;
3595 }
3596 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003597 }
3598 }
3599 }
3600
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003601 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003602 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3603 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3604 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3605 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003606 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003607 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003608 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3609 I.getType(), TD) &&
3610 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3611 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003612 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
3613 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3614 I.getName());
3615 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
3616 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
3617 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003618 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003619
3620 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003621 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3622 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3623 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003624 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3625 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3626 Instruction *NewOp =
3627 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
3628 SI1->getOperand(0),
3629 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003630 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3631 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003632 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003633 }
3634
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003635 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
3636 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
3637 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3638 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
3639 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD)
3640 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3641 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3642 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3643 // false.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00003644 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003645 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3646 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS->getOperand(0),
3647 RHS->getOperand(0));
3648 }
3649 }
3650 }
3651
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003652 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003653}
3654
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003655/// CollectBSwapParts - Look to see if the specified value defines a single byte
3656/// in the result. If it does, and if the specified byte hasn't been filled in
3657/// yet, fill it in and return false.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003658static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003659 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
3660 if (I == 0) return true;
3661
3662 // If this is an or instruction, it is an inner node of the bswap.
3663 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or)
3664 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3665 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), ByteValues);
3666
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003667 uint32_t BitWidth = I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003668 // If this is a shift by a constant int, and it is "24", then its operand
3669 // defines a byte. We only handle unsigned types here.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003670 if (I->isShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003671 // Not shifting the entire input by N-1 bytes?
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003672 if (cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) !=
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003673 8*(ByteValues.size()-1))
3674 return true;
3675
3676 unsigned DestNo;
3677 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
3678 // X << 24 defines the top byte with the lowest of the input bytes.
3679 DestNo = ByteValues.size()-1;
3680 } else {
3681 // X >>u 24 defines the low byte with the highest of the input bytes.
3682 DestNo = 0;
3683 }
3684
3685 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3686 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3687 if (ByteValues[DestNo] && ByteValues[DestNo] != I->getOperand(0))
3688 return true;
3689 ByteValues[DestNo] = I->getOperand(0);
3690 return false;
3691 }
3692
3693 // Otherwise, we can only handle and(shift X, imm), imm). Bail out of if we
3694 // don't have this.
3695 Value *Shift = 0, *ShiftLHS = 0;
3696 ConstantInt *AndAmt = 0, *ShiftAmt = 0;
3697 if (!match(I, m_And(m_Value(Shift), m_ConstantInt(AndAmt))) ||
3698 !match(Shift, m_Shift(m_Value(ShiftLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
3699 return true;
3700 Instruction *SI = cast<Instruction>(Shift);
3701
3702 // Make sure that the shift amount is by a multiple of 8 and isn't too big.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003703 if (ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) & 7 ||
3704 ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) > 8*ByteValues.size())
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003705 return true;
3706
3707 // Turn 0xFF -> 0, 0xFF00 -> 1, 0xFF0000 -> 2, etc.
3708 unsigned DestByte;
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003709 if (AndAmt->getValue().getActiveBits() > 64)
3710 return true;
3711 uint64_t AndAmtVal = AndAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003712 for (DestByte = 0; DestByte != ByteValues.size(); ++DestByte)
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003713 if (AndAmtVal == uint64_t(0xFF) << 8*DestByte)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003714 break;
3715 // Unknown mask for bswap.
3716 if (DestByte == ByteValues.size()) return true;
3717
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003718 unsigned ShiftBytes = ShiftAmt->getZExtValue()/8;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003719 unsigned SrcByte;
3720 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
3721 SrcByte = DestByte - ShiftBytes;
3722 else
3723 SrcByte = DestByte + ShiftBytes;
3724
3725 // If the SrcByte isn't a bswapped value from the DestByte, reject it.
3726 if (SrcByte != ByteValues.size()-DestByte-1)
3727 return true;
3728
3729 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3730 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3731 if (ByteValues[DestByte] && ByteValues[DestByte] != SI->getOperand(0))
3732 return true;
3733 ByteValues[DestByte] = SI->getOperand(0);
3734 return false;
3735}
3736
3737/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
3738/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
3739Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003740 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
3741 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16)
3742 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003743
3744 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
3745 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003746 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003747 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003748
3749 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
3750 if (CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3751 CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(1), ByteValues))
3752 return 0;
3753
3754 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
3755 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
3756 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
3757
3758 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
3759 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
3760 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
3761 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003762 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003763 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003764 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003765 return new CallInst(F, V);
3766}
3767
3768
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003769Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003770 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003771 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003772
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003773 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003774 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003775
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003776 // or X, X = X
3777 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003778 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003779
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003780 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3781 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003782 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3783 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3784 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3785 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3786 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3787 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003788 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3789 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
3790 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3791 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
3792 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003793 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003794
3795
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003796
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003797 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003798 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003799 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003800 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
3801 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003802 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003803 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003804 Or->takeName(Op0);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003805 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or,
3806 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003807 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003808
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003809 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
3810 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003811 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003812 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003813 Or->takeName(Op0);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003814 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003815 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003816 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003817
3818 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3819 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003820 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003821 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003822 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3823 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3824 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003825 }
3826
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003827 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
3828 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003829
3830 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3831 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
3832 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3833 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3834 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
3835 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3836
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003837 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
3838 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003839 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003840 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
3841 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
3842 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003843 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
3844 return BSwap;
3845 }
3846
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003847 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3848 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003849 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003850 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op1);
3851 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3852 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3853 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003854 }
3855
3856 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3857 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003858 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003859 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op0);
3860 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3861 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3862 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003863 }
3864
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003865 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00003866 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003867 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
3868 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00003869 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
3870 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
3871 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
3872 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
3873 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
3874 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
3875 // replace with V+N.
3876 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
3877 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
3878 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3879 // Add commutes, try both ways.
3880 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
3881 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3882 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
3883 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3884 }
3885 // Or commutes, try both ways.
3886 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
3887 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3888 // Add commutes, try both ways.
3889 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
3890 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
3891 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
3892 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
3893 }
3894 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00003895 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00003896 }
3897
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003898 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
3899 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003900 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3901 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
3902 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
3903 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
3904 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
3905 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
3906 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
3907 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
3908 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
3909
3910 if (V1) {
3911 Value *Or =
3912 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
3913 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003914 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003915 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003916 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003917
3918 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003919 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3920 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3921 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003922 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3923 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3924 Instruction *NewOp =
3925 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
3926 SI1->getOperand(0),
3927 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003928 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3929 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003930 }
3931 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00003932
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003933 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
3934 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003935 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003936 } else {
3937 A = 0;
3938 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003939 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003940 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
3941 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003942 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003943
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003944 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003945 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3946 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, B,
3947 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
3948 return BinaryOperator::createNot(And);
3949 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003950 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003951
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003952 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3953 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3954 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003955 return R;
3956
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003957 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3958 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003959 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3960 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3961 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3962 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
3963 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
3964 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3965 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3966 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003967 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3968 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
3969 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003970 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003971 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003972 bool NeedsSwap;
3973 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00003974 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003975 else
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00003976 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003977
3978 if (NeedsSwap) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003979 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3980 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3981 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3982 }
3983
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003984 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003985 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
3986 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003987 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
3988 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003989 // equal.
3990 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3991
3992 switch (LHSCC) {
3993 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003994 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003995 switch (RHSCC) {
3996 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003997 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003998 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
3999 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
4000 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
4001 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
4002 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004003 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004004 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004005 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004006 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4007 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4008 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner240d6f42005-04-19 06:04:18 +00004009 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004010 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4011 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4012 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004013 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4014 }
4015 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004016 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004017 switch (RHSCC) {
4018 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004019 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4020 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4021 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004022 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004023 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4024 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4025 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004026 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004027 }
4028 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004029 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004030 switch (RHSCC) {
4031 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004032 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004033 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004034 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004035 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4036 // this can cause overflow.
4037 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4038 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004039 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
4040 false, I);
4041 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4042 break;
4043 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4044 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004045 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004046 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4047 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004048 }
4049 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004050 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004051 switch (RHSCC) {
4052 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004053 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4054 break;
4055 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004056 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4057 // this can cause overflow.
4058 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4059 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004060 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
4061 false, I);
4062 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4063 break;
4064 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4065 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4066 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4067 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4068 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004069 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004070 break;
4071 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4072 switch (RHSCC) {
4073 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4074 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4075 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4076 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4077 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4078 break;
4079 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4080 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004081 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004082 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4083 break;
4084 }
4085 break;
4086 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4087 switch (RHSCC) {
4088 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4089 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4090 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4091 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4092 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4093 break;
4094 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4095 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004096 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004097 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4098 break;
4099 }
4100 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004101 }
4102 }
4103 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004104
4105 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004106 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004107 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004108 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
4109 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004110 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004111 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004112 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4113 I.getType(), TD) &&
4114 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4115 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004116 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4117 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4118 I.getName());
4119 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
4120 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
4121 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004122 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004123 }
4124
4125
4126 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4127 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4128 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4129 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
4130 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO)
4131 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4132 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4133 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4134 // true.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004135 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004136 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4137
4138 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4139 // rest.
4140 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS->getOperand(0),
4141 RHS->getOperand(0));
4142 }
4143 }
4144 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004145
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004146 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004147}
4148
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004149// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4150struct XorSelf {
4151 Value *RHS;
4152 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4153 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4154 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4155 return &Xor;
4156 }
4157};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004158
4159
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004160Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004161 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004162 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004163
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004164 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
4165 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
4166
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004167 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4168 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004169 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004170 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004171 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004172
4173 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4174 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004175 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4176 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4177 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4178 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4179 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4180 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004181 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4182 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004183 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004184
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004185 // Is this a ~ operation?
4186 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4187 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4188 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4189 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4190 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4191 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4192 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4193 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4194 Instruction *NotY =
4195 BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
4196 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4197 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4198 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
4199 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
4200 else
4201 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
4202 }
4203 }
4204 }
4205 }
4206
4207
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004208 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004209 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4210 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4211 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004212 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4213 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004214
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004215 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4216 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4217 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4218 }
4219
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004220 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004221 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004222 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4223 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004224 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4225 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004226 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004227 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004228 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004229
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004230 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004231 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004232 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004233 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004234 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
4235 return BinaryOperator::createSub(
4236 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004237 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004238 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004239 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004240 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4241 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
4242 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004243
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004244 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004245 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4246 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004247 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004248 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4249 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4250 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004251 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004252 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4253 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004254 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004255 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4256 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4257 return &I;
4258 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004259 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004260 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004261
4262 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4263 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004264 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004265 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004266 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4267 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4268 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004269 }
4270
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004271 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004272 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004273 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004274
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004275 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004276 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004277 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004278
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004279
4280 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4281 if (Op1I) {
4282 Value *A, *B;
4283 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4284 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004285 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004286 I.swapOperands();
4287 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004288 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004289 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004290 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004291 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004292 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4293 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4294 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4295 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4296 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4297 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004298 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004299 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004300 std::swap(A, B);
4301 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004302 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004303 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4304 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4305 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004306 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004307 }
4308
4309 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4310 if (Op0I) {
4311 Value *A, *B;
4312 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4313 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4314 std::swap(A, B);
4315 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4316 Instruction *NotB =
4317 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4318 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004319 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004320 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4321 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4322 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4323 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4324 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4325 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4326 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4327 std::swap(A, B);
4328 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004329 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004330 Instruction *N =
4331 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(A, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004332 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(N, Op1);
4333 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004334 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004335 }
4336
4337 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4338 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4339 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4340 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4341 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4342 Instruction *NewOp =
4343 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
4344 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4345 Op0I->getName()), I);
4346 return BinaryOperator::create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
4347 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4348 }
4349
4350 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4351 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4352 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4353 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4354 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4355 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4356 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4357 }
4358 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4359 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4360 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4361 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4362 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4363 }
4364
4365 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4366 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4367 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4368 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4369 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4370 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4371 if (A == C)
4372 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4373 else if (A == D)
4374 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4375 else if (B == C)
4376 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4377 else if (B == D)
4378 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4379
4380 if (X) {
4381 Instruction *NewOp =
4382 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4383 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewOp, X);
4384 }
4385 }
4386 }
4387
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004388 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4389 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4390 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004391 return R;
4392
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004393 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004394 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004395 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004396 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4397 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004398 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004399 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004400 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4401 I.getType(), TD) &&
4402 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4403 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004404 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4405 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4406 I.getName());
4407 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
4408 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
4409 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004410 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004411 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004412 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004413}
4414
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004415/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4416/// overflowed for this type.
4417static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004418 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004419 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004420
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004421 if (IsSigned)
4422 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4423 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4424 else
4425 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4426 else
4427 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004428}
4429
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004430/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4431/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4432/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4433static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4434 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4435 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004436 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4437 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004438
4439 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004440 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSize()*8;
4441 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004442
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004443 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4444 Value *Op = GEP->getOperand(i);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00004445 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004446 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
4447 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
4448
4449 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4450 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4451 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
4452
4453 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
4454 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004455 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004456 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
4457 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result,
4458 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
4459 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4460 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004461 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004462
4463 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4464 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
4465 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
4466 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4467 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4468 else {
4469 // Emit an add instruction.
4470 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
4471 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result, Scale,
4472 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004473 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004474 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004475 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004476 // Convert to correct type.
4477 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
4478 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4479 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
4480 else
4481 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
4482 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4483 }
4484 if (Size != 1) {
4485 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4486 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4487 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
4488 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
4489 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(Op, Scale,
4490 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
4491 }
4492
4493 // Emit an add instruction.
4494 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
4495 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
4496 cast<Constant>(Result));
4497 else
4498 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op, Result,
4499 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004500 }
4501 return Result;
4502}
4503
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004504/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004505/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004506Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
4507 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
4508 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004509 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004510
4511 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS))
4512 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
4513 RHS = CI->getOperand(0);
4514
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004515 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
4516 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
4517 // As an optimization, we don't actually have to compute the actual value of
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004518 // OFFSET if this is a icmp_eq or icmp_ne comparison, just return whether
4519 // each index is zero or not.
4520 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) {
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004521 Instruction *InVal = 0;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004522 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEPLHS);
4523 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004524 bool EmitIt = true;
4525 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))) {
4526 if (isa<UndefValue>(C)) // undef index -> undef.
4527 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
4528 if (C->isNullValue())
4529 EmitIt = false;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00004530 else if (TD->getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) == 0) {
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004531 EmitIt = false; // This is indexing into a zero sized array?
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004532 } else if (isa<ConstantInt>(C))
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004533 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004534 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4535 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004536 }
4537
4538 if (EmitIt) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004539 Instruction *Comp =
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004540 new ICmpInst(Cond, GEPLHS->getOperand(i),
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004541 Constant::getNullValue(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()));
4542 if (InVal == 0)
4543 InVal = Comp;
4544 else {
4545 InVal = InsertNewInstBefore(InVal, I);
4546 InsertNewInstBefore(Comp, I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004547 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) // True if any are unequal
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004548 InVal = BinaryOperator::createOr(InVal, Comp);
4549 else // True if all are equal
4550 InVal = BinaryOperator::createAnd(InVal, Comp);
4551 }
4552 }
4553 }
4554
4555 if (InVal)
4556 return InVal;
4557 else
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004558 // No comparison is needed here, all indexes = 0
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004559 ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4560 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ));
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004561 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004562
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004563 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004564 // the result to fold to a constant!
4565 if (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) {
4566 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
4567 Value *Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004568 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
4569 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004570 }
4571 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004572 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
4573 // compare the base pointer.
4574 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
4575 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00004576 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00004577 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004578 if (IndicesTheSame)
4579 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4580 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
4581 IndicesTheSame = false;
4582 break;
4583 }
4584
4585 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
4586 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004587 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
4588 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004589
4590 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
4591 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004592 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004593 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004594
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004595 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
4596 bool AllZeros = true;
4597 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4598 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4599 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4600 AllZeros = false;
4601 break;
4602 }
4603 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004604 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
4605 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004606
4607 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004608 AllZeros = true;
4609 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4610 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4611 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4612 AllZeros = false;
4613 break;
4614 }
4615 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004616 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004617
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004618 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
4619 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
4620 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
4621 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
4622 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4623 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004624 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
4625 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004626 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004627 NumDifferences = 2;
4628 break;
4629 } else {
4630 if (NumDifferences++) break;
4631 DiffOperand = i;
4632 }
4633 }
4634
4635 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
4636 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00004637 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4638 isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
4639
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004640 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004641 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
4642 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004643 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
4644 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004645 }
4646 }
4647
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004648 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004649 // the result to fold to a constant!
4650 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
4651 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
4652 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
4653 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4654 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004655 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004656 }
4657 }
4658 return 0;
4659}
4660
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004661Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
4662 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004663 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004664
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00004665 // Fold trivial predicates.
4666 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4667 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
4668 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4669 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4670
4671 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
4672 if (Op0 == Op1) {
4673 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4674 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
4675 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
4676 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
4677 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
4678 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4679 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
4680 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
4681 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
4682 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4683
4684 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
4685 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
4686 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
4687 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
4688 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
4689 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
4690 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4691 return &I;
4692
4693 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
4694 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
4695 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
4696 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
4697 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
4698 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
4699 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4700 return &I;
4701 }
4702 }
4703
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004704 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004705 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004706
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004707 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
4708 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
4709 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
4710 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
4711 case Instruction::PHI:
4712 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4713 return NV;
4714 break;
4715 case Instruction::Select:
4716 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
4717 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
4718 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
4719 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
4720 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4721 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
4722 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4723 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4724 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4725 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4726 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
4727 I.getName()), I);
4728 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
4729 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4730 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4731 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4732 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4733 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
4734 I.getName()), I);
4735 }
4736 }
4737
4738 if (Op1)
4739 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
4740 break;
4741 }
4742 }
4743
4744 return Changed ? &I : 0;
4745}
4746
4747Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
4748 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
4749 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
4750 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
4751
4752 // icmp X, X
4753 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004754 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4755 isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004756
4757 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004758 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004759
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004760 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004761 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004762 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
4763 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
4764 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004765 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004766 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4767 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004768
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004769 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004770 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004771 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4772 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
4773 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> ~(A^B)
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004774 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004775 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004776 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004777 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004778 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> A^B
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004779 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004780
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004781 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4782 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4783 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp gt -> icmp lt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004784 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004785 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4786 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp lt bool A, B -> ~X & Y
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004787 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4788 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4789 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Not, Op1);
4790 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004791 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4792 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4793 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ge -> icmp le
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004794 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004795 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4796 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp le bool %A, %B -> ~A | B
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004797 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4798 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4799 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Not, Op1);
4800 }
4801 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004802 }
4803
Chris Lattner2be51ae2004-06-09 04:24:29 +00004804 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
4805 // can be folded into the comparison.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004806 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004807 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4808 default: break;
4809 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // A <u MIN -> FALSE
4810 if (CI->isMinValue(false))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004811 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004812 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
4813 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0,Op1);
4814 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4815 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00004816 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
4817 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
4818 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
4819 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
4820
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004821 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004822
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004823 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4824 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <s MIN -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004825 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004826 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
4827 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4828 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4829 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4830 break;
4831
4832 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4833 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >u MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004834 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004835 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
4836 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4837 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, false)) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4838 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00004839
4840 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
4841 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
4842 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
4843 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004844 break;
4845
4846 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4847 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >s MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004848 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004849 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
4850 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4851 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, true)) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4852 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4853 break;
4854
4855 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4856 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004857 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004858 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A <=u MIN -> A == MIN
4859 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4860 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,false)) // A <=u MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4861 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4862 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004863
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004864 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4865 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004866 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004867 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <=s MIN -> A == MIN
4868 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4869 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,true)) // A <=s MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4870 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4871 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004872
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004873 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4874 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004875 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004876 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >=u MAX -> A == MAX
4877 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4878 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A >=u MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4879 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4880 break;
4881
4882 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4883 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004884 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004885 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >=s MAX -> A == MAX
4886 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4887 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A >=s MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4888 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4889 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004890 }
4891
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004892 // If we still have a icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
4893 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. Since the border cases have
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004894 // already been handled above, this requires little checking.
4895 //
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00004896 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004897 default: break;
4898 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4899 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4900 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4901 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4902 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4903 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4904 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4905 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00004906 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004907
4908 // See if we can fold the comparison based on bits known to be zero or one
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004909 // in the input. If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
4910 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
4911
4912 bool UnusedBit;
4913 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
4914
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004915 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
4916 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004917 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
4918 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
4919 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004920 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
4921 return &I;
4922
4923 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
4924 // in.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004925 if ((KnownOne | KnownZero) != 0) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004926 // Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
4927 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00004928 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
4929 const APInt& RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004930 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004931 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4932 Max);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004933 } else {
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004934 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4935 Max);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004936 }
4937 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
4938 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
4939 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004940 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004941 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004942 break;
4943 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004944 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004945 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004946 break;
4947 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004948 if (Max.ult(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004949 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004950 if (Min.uge(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004951 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004952 break;
4953 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004954 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004955 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004956 if (Max.ule(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004957 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004958 break;
4959 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004960 if (Max.slt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004961 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004962 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004963 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004964 break;
4965 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004966 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004967 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004968 if (Max.sle(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004969 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004970 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004971 }
4972 }
4973
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004974 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004975 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004976 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00004977 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00004978 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
4979 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004980 }
4981
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00004982 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004983 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
4984 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
4985 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004986 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
4987 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004988 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004989 bool isAllZeros = true;
4990 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4991 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
4992 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4993 isAllZeros = false;
4994 break;
4995 }
4996 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004997 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004998 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
4999 }
5000 break;
5001
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005002 case Instruction::PHI:
5003 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5004 return NV;
5005 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005006 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005007 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5008 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5009 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5010 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5011 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5012 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5013 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005014 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5015 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5016 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5017 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5018 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005019 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5020 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005021 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5022 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5023 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5024 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5025 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005026 }
5027 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005028
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005029 if (Op1)
5030 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
5031 break;
5032 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005033 case Instruction::Malloc:
5034 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
5035 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
5036 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
5037 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5038 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5039 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
5040 }
5041 break;
5042 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005043 }
5044
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005045 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005046 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005047 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005048 return NI;
5049 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005050 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5051 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005052 return NI;
5053
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005054 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005055 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5056 // now.
5057 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5058 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5059 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005060 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5061 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005062 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005063
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005064 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5065 // so eliminate it as well.
5066 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5067 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005068
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005069 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005070 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType())
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005071 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005072 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005073 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005074 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00005075 Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005076 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005077 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005078 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005079 }
5080
5081 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005082 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005083 // This comes up when you have code like
5084 // int X = A < B;
5085 // if (X) ...
5086 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005087 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5088 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005089 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005090 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005091 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005092
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005093 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005094 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
5095 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5096 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5097 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5098 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5099 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5100 }
5101
5102 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5103 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5104 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5105 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5106 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00005107 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005108 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(C, NC, "tmp");
5109 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5110 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5111 }
5112
5113 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5114 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5115 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5116 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5117 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5118 }
5119 }
5120
5121 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5122 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005123 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5124 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005125 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5126 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005127 }
5128 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005129 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005130 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5131 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005132 }
5133 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005134 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005135 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5136 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005137 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005138
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005139 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5140 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5141 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5142 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5143 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5144
5145 if (A == C) {
5146 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5147 } else if (A == D) {
5148 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5149 } else if (B == C) {
5150 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5151 } else if (B == D) {
5152 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5153 }
5154
5155 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
5156 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5157 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
5158 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5159 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5160 return &I;
5161 }
5162 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005163 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005164 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005165}
5166
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005167
5168/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
5169/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
5170Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
5171 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
5172 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5173 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
5174
5175 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
5176 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
5177 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
5178 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
5179 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
5180 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
5181 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
5182 // if it finds it.
5183 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
5184 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
5185 return 0;
5186 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005187 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005188
5189 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
5190 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
5191 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
5192 // instead of computing a divide.
5193 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
5194
5195 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
5196 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
5197 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
5198 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
5199 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
5200
5201 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005202 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005203
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005204 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
5205 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
5206 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
5207 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
5208 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
5209 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
5210 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
5211 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
5212 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
5213
5214
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005215 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005216 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005217 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005218 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5219 if (!HiOverflow)
5220 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005221 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
5222 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005223 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005224 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
5225 HiBound = DivRHS;
5226 } else if (CmpRHSV.isPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005227 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
5228 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5229 if (!HiOverflow)
5230 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005231 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005232 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005233 Constant *DivRHSH = ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS));
5234 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod,
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005235 cast<ConstantInt>(DivRHSH), true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005236 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005237 HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005238 }
5239 } else { // Divisor is < 0.
5240 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005241 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005242 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
5243 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005244 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
5245 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
5246 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
5247 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005248 } else if (CmpRHSV.isPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005249 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
5250 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005251 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005252 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod, AddOne(DivRHS), true) ?-1:0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005253 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
5254 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005255 // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005256 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005257 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? 1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005258 HiBound = Subtract(Prod, DivRHS);
5259 }
5260
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005261 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
5262 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005263 }
5264
5265 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005266 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005267 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
5268 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5269 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5270 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5271 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005272 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005273 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
5274 else if (LoOverflow)
5275 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5276 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
5277 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005278 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005279 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5280 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5281 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5282 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005283 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005284 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
5285 else if (LoOverflow)
5286 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5287 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5288 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005289 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005290 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5291 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005292 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
5293 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5294 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005295 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005296 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005297 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5298 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005299 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005300 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005301 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
5302 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5303 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005304 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5305 else
5306 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
5307 }
5308}
5309
5310
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005311/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
5312///
5313Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
5314 Instruction *LHSI,
5315 ConstantInt *RHS) {
5316 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
5317
5318 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00005319 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005320 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5321 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
5322 // fold the xor.
5323 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0 ||
5324 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue()) {
5325 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
5326
5327 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
5328 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
5329 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
5330 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
5331 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5332 return &ICI;
5333 }
5334
5335 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
5336 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5337
5338 // If so, the new one isn't.
5339 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
5340
5341 if (isTrueIfPositive)
5342 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
5343 else
5344 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
5345 }
5346 }
5347 break;
5348 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
5349 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
5350 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
5351 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5352
5353 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
5354 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
5355 // produced, eliminating a cast.
5356 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
5357 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
5358 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
5359 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
5360 // bit would not work.
5361 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
5362 (ICI.isEquality() || AndCST->getValue().isPositive() &&
5363 RHSV.isPositive())) {
5364 uint32_t BitWidth =
5365 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
5366 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
5367 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
5368 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
5369 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
5370 Instruction *NewAnd =
5371 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
5372 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
5373 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5374 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
5375 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
5376 }
5377 }
5378
5379 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
5380 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
5381 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
5382 // access.
5383 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
5384 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
5385 Shift = 0;
5386
5387 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
5388 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
5389 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
5390 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
5391
5392 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
5393 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
5394 // rights, as they sign-extend.
5395 if (ShAmt) {
5396 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
5397 if (!CanFold) {
5398 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
5399 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
5400 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5401 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
5402
5403 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5404 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
5405 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
5406 CanFold = true;
5407 }
5408
5409 if (CanFold) {
5410 Constant *NewCst;
5411 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5412 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
5413 else
5414 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
5415
5416 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
5417 // compared.
5418 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
5419 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
5420 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
5421 // result is always true or false now.
5422 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
5423 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5424 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
5425 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5426 } else {
5427 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
5428 Constant *NewAndCST;
5429 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5430 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
5431 else
5432 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
5433 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
5434 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
5435 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
5436 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
5437 return &ICI;
5438 }
5439 }
5440 }
5441
5442 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
5443 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
5444 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
5445 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
5446 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
5447 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
5448 // Compute C << Y.
5449 Value *NS;
5450 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5451 NS = BinaryOperator::createShl(AndCST,
5452 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5453 } else {
5454 // Insert a logical shift.
5455 NS = BinaryOperator::createLShr(AndCST,
5456 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5457 }
5458 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
5459
5460 // Compute X & (C << Y).
5461 Instruction *NewAnd =
5462 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
5463 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5464
5465 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
5466 return &ICI;
5467 }
5468 }
5469 break;
5470
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005471 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
5472 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5473 if (!ShAmt) break;
5474
5475 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5476
5477 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5478 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5479 // simplified.
5480 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5481 break;
5482
5483 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5484 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5485 // comparison cannot succeed.
5486 Constant *Comp =
5487 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
5488 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5489 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5490 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5491 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5492 }
5493
5494 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5495 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5496 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5497 Constant *Mask =
5498 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005499
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005500 Instruction *AndI =
5501 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5502 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5503 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5504 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5505 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005506 }
5507 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005508
5509 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
5510 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
5511 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
5512 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
5513 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
5514 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
5515 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
5516 Instruction *AndI =
5517 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5518 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5519 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5520
5521 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
5522 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
5523 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005524 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005525 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005526
5527 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005528 case Instruction::AShr: {
5529 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5530 if (!ShAmt) break;
5531
5532 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5533 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5534 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5535 // simplified.
5536 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5537 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5538 break;
5539 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5540
5541 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5542 // comparison cannot succeed.
5543 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
5544 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
5545 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
5546 else
5547 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
5548
5549 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5550 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5551 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5552 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5553 }
5554
5555 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() || RHSV == 0) {
5556 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5557 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
5558 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005559
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005560 Instruction *AndI =
5561 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5562 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5563 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5564 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5565 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005566 }
5567 }
5568 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005569 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005570
5571 case Instruction::SDiv:
5572 case Instruction::UDiv:
5573 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
5574 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
5575 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
5576 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
5577 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
5578 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005579 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
5580 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
5581 DivRHS))
5582 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005583 break;
5584 }
5585
5586 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
5587 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5588 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5589
5590 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
5591 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
5592 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
5593 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
5594 case Instruction::SRem:
5595 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
5596 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
5597 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
5598 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
5599 Instruction *NewRem =
5600 BinaryOperator::createURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
5601 BO->getName());
5602 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
5603 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
5604 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
5605 }
5606 }
5607 break;
5608 case Instruction::Add:
5609 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
5610 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5611 if (BO->hasOneUse())
5612 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5613 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
5614 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
5615 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
5616 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
5617 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
5618
5619 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
5620 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
5621 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
5622 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
5623 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
5624 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::createNeg(BOp1);
5625 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
5626 Neg->takeName(BO);
5627 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
5628 }
5629 }
5630 break;
5631 case Instruction::Xor:
5632 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
5633 // the explicit xor.
5634 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5635 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5636 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
5637
5638 // FALLTHROUGH
5639 case Instruction::Sub:
5640 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
5641 if (RHSV == 0)
5642 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5643 BO->getOperand(1));
5644 break;
5645
5646 case Instruction::Or:
5647 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
5648 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
5649 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5650 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
5651 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
5652 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5653 isICMP_NE));
5654 }
5655 break;
5656
5657 case Instruction::And:
5658 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5659 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
5660 // comparison can never succeed!
5661 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
5662 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5663 isICMP_NE));
5664
5665 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
5666 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
5667 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
5668 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
5669 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
5670
5671 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
5672 if (isSignBit(BOC)) {
5673 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
5674 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
5675 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5676 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5677 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
5678 }
5679
5680 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
5681 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
5682 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
5683 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
5684 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5685 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
5686 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
5687 }
5688 }
5689 default: break;
5690 }
5691 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
5692 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
5693 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
5694 AddToWorkList(II);
5695 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
5696 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
5697 return &ICI;
5698 }
5699 }
5700 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00005701 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
5702 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005703 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
5704 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
5705 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
5706 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5707 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
5708 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
5709 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
5710 // smaller constant values.
5711 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
5712 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
5713 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
5714 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
5715 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
5716 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
5717 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
5718 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
5719 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
5720 }
5721 }
5722 }
5723 }
5724 return 0;
5725}
5726
5727/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
5728/// We only handle extending casts so far.
5729///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005730Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
5731 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005732 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
5733 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005734 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005735 Value *RHSCIOp;
5736
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00005737 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
5738 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
5739 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
5740 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
5741 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
5742 Value *RHSOp = 0;
5743 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00005744 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00005745 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
5746 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
5747 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
5748 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
5749 RHSOp = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, RHSOp,
5750 LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
5751 }
5752
5753 if (RHSOp)
5754 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
5755 }
5756
5757 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
5758 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005759 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
5760 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00005761 return 0;
5762
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005763 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
5764 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005765
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005766 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005767 // Not an extension from the same type?
5768 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005769 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
5770 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00005771
5772 // If the signedness of the two compares doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
5773 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
5774 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
5775 return 0;
5776
5777 // Likewise, if the signedness of the [sz]exts and the compare don't match,
5778 // then we can't handle this.
5779 if (isSignedExt != isSignedCmp && !ICI.isEquality())
5780 return 0;
5781
5782 // Okay, just insert a compare of the reduced operands now!
5783 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00005784 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005785
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005786 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
5787 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5788 if (!CI)
5789 return 0;
5790
5791 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
5792 // reextended to DestTy.
5793 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
5794 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
5795
5796 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
5797 if (Res2 == CI) {
5798 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
5799 // For example, we might have:
5800 // %A = sext short %X to uint
5801 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
5802 // It is incorrect to transform this into
5803 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
5804 // because %A may have negative value.
5805 //
5806 // However, it is OK if SrcTy is bool (See cast-set.ll testcase)
5807 // OR operation is EQ/NE.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005808 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || SrcTy == Type::Int1Ty || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005809 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
5810 else
5811 return 0;
5812 }
5813
5814 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
5815 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
5816
5817 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
5818 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
5819 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005820 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005821 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005822 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005823
5824 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
5825 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
5826 Value *Result;
5827 if (isSignedCmp) {
5828 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005829 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005830 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005831 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005832 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005833 } else {
5834 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
5835 if (isSignedExt) {
5836 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
5837 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005838 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005839 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
5840 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
5841 } else {
5842 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005843 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005844 }
5845 }
5846
5847 // Finally, return the value computed.
5848 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5849 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT) {
5850 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
5851 } else {
5852 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
5853 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
5854 "ICmp should be folded!");
5855 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
5856 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
5857 else
5858 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Result);
5859 }
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005860}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005861
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005862Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
5863 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5864}
5865
5866Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5867 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5868}
5869
5870Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5871 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5872}
5873
5874Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
5875 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005876 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005877
5878 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
5879 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005880 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00005881 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
5882 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005883
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005884 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
5885 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00005886 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005887 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005888 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
5889 }
5890 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005891 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
5892 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
5893 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005894 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005895 }
5896
Chris Lattnerde2b6602006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005897 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
5898 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005899 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerde2b6602006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005900 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005901 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
5902
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005903 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5904 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
5905 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005906 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005907 return R;
5908
Chris Lattner120347e2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005909 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005910 if (I.isArithmeticShift()) {
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005911 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
5912 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()))) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005913 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Chris Lattner120347e2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005914 }
5915 }
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005916
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005917 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005918 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
5919 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005920 return 0;
5921}
5922
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005923Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005924 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005925 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005926
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005927 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5928 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005929 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5930 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
5931 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005932 KnownZero, KnownOne))
5933 return &I;
5934
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005935 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
5936 // of a signed value.
5937 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00005938 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005939 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005940 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5941 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005942 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005943 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00005944 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005945 }
5946
5947 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
5948 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
5949 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
5950 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5951 return BinaryOperator::createMul(BO->getOperand(0),
5952 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
5953
5954 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5955 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
5956 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
5957 return R;
5958 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
5959 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5960 return NV;
5961
5962 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005963 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5964 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
5965 Value *V1, *V2;
5966 ConstantInt *CC;
5967 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005968 default: break;
5969 case Instruction::Add:
5970 case Instruction::And:
5971 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005972 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005973 // These operators commute.
5974 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005975 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
5976 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005977 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005978 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005979 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005980 Op0BO->getName());
5981 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005982 Instruction *X =
5983 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
5984 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005985 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00005986 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00005987 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
5988 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005989 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005990
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005991 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005992 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00005993 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005994 match(Op0BOOp1,
5995 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00005996 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5997 V2 == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005998 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005999 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
6000 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006001 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6002 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006003 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006004 V1->getName()+".mask");
6005 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6006
6007 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
6008 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006009 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006010
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006011 // FALL THROUGH.
6012 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006013 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006014 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6015 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006016 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006017 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006018 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6019 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006020 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006021 Instruction *X =
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00006022 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006023 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006024 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006025 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006026 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
6027 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006028 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006029
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00006030 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006031 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6032 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
6033 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006034 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006035 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
6036 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006037 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006038 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6039 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006040 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6041 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006042 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006043 V1->getName()+".mask");
6044 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6045
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00006046 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006047 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006048
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006049 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006050 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006051 }
6052
6053
6054 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
6055 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
6056 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
6057 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
6058 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
6059
6060 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006061 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00006062 case Instruction::Add:
6063 isValid = isLeftShift;
6064 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006065 case Instruction::Or:
6066 case Instruction::Xor:
6067 highBitSet = false;
6068 break;
6069 case Instruction::And:
6070 highBitSet = true;
6071 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006072 }
6073
6074 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
6075 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
6076 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
6077 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
6078 // operation.
6079 //
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006080 if (isValid && !isLeftShift && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006081 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006082 }
6083
6084 if (isValid) {
6085 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
6086
6087 Instruction *NewShift =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006088 BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006089 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006090 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006091
6092 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
6093 NewRHS);
6094 }
6095 }
6096 }
6097 }
6098
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006099 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006100 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
6101 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
6102 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006103
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006104 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006105 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006106 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6107 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006108 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
6109 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
6110 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006111
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006112 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006113 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
6114 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006115
6116 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
6117
6118 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00006119 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006120 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), X,
6121 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6122 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
6123 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
6124 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
6125 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6126 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
6127 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6128 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
6129 Instruction *Shift =
6130 BinaryOperator::createAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6131 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6132
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006133 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006134 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006135 }
6136
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006137 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
6138 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
6139 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
6140 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
6141 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006142 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006143 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006144 }
6145 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
6146 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00006147 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006148 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006149 }
6150 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
6151 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
6152 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
6153 // generators.
6154 const Type *SExtType = 0;
6155 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006156 case 1 :
6157 case 8 :
6158 case 16 :
6159 case 32 :
6160 case 64 :
6161 case 128:
6162 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
6163 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006164 default: break;
6165 }
6166 if (SExtType) {
6167 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
6168 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
6169 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
6170 }
6171 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
6172 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006173 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006174
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006175 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006176 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6177 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6178 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006179 Instruction *Shift =
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006180 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006181 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6182
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006183 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
6184 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006185 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006186
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006187 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006188 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6189 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6190 Instruction *Shift =
6191 BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6192 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006193
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00006194 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006195 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006196 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006197
6198 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
6199 } else {
6200 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006201 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006202
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006203 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006204 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6205 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6206 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
6207 Instruction *Shift =
6208 BinaryOperator::create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
6209 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6210 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6211
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006212 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006213 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006214 }
6215
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006216 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006217 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6218 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6219 Instruction *Shift =
6220 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6221 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6222
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00006223 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006224 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006225 }
6226
6227 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006228 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006229 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006230 return 0;
6231}
6232
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00006233
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006234/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
6235/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
6236/// X*Scale+Offset.
6237///
6238static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006239 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006240 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006241 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006242 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00006243 Scale = 0;
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006244 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00006245 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
6246 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
6247 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6248 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
6249 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
6250 Offset = 0;
6251 return I->getOperand(0);
6252 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
6253 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
6254 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
6255 Offset = 0;
6256 return I->getOperand(0);
6257 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6258 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
6259 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
6260 unsigned SubScale;
6261 Value *SubVal =
6262 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
6263 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
6264 Scale = SubScale;
6265 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006266 }
6267 }
6268 }
6269
6270 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
6271 Scale = 1;
6272 Offset = 0;
6273 return Val;
6274}
6275
6276
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006277/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
6278/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006279Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006280 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006281 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006282
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006283 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
6284 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00006285
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006286 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
6287 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
6288 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
6289 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
6290 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
6291
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006292 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00006293 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00006294 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006295 }
6296 }
6297
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006298 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
6299 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
6300 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
6301 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006302
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00006303 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
6304 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006305 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6306
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006307 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
6308 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
6309 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
6310 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6311
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00006312 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(AllocElTy);
6313 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006314 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006315
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006316 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
6317 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006318 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
6319 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006320 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
6321 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
6322
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006323 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
6324 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006325 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
6326 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006327
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006328 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
6329 Value *Amt = 0;
6330 if (Scale == 1) {
6331 Amt = NumElements;
6332 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006333 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006334 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
6335 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00006336 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006337 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006338 else if (Scale != 1) {
6339 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
6340 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006341 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006342 }
6343
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006344 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
6345 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006346 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
6347 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
6348 }
6349
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006350 AllocationInst *New;
6351 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006352 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006353 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006354 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006355 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006356 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006357
6358 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
6359 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
6360 // die soon.
6361 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
6362 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006363 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
6364 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
6365 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006366 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
6367 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
6368 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006369 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
6370}
6371
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006372/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006373/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
6374/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
6375/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
6376/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
6377///
6378/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
6379/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
6380static bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006381 unsigned CastOpc, int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006382 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
6383 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
6384 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006385
6386 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006387 if (!I) return false;
6388
6389 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006390
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006391 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
6392 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
6393 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
6394 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
6395 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
6396 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
6397 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
6398 // casts first.
6399 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)))
6400 ++NumCastsRemoved;
6401 return true;
6402 }
6403 }
6404
6405 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
6406 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
6407 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6408
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006409 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006410 case Instruction::Add:
6411 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006412 case Instruction::And:
6413 case Instruction::Or:
6414 case Instruction::Xor:
6415 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006416 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6417 NumCastsRemoved) &&
6418 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
6419 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006420
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006421 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006422 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
6423 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
6424 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006425 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6426 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
6427 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006428 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6429 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006430 }
6431 break;
6432 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006433 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
6434 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
6435 // already zeros.
6436 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006437 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
6438 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6439 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006440 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006441 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
6442 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006443 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6444 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006445 }
6446 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006447 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006448 case Instruction::ZExt:
6449 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006450 case Instruction::Trunc:
6451 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00006452 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
6453 // of casts in the input.
6454 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006455 return true;
Chris Lattner50d9d772007-09-10 23:46:29 +00006456
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006457 break;
6458 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006459 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6460 break;
6461 }
6462
6463 return false;
6464}
6465
6466/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
6467/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
6468/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006469Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006470 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006471 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006472 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006473
6474 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
6475 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00006476 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006477 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006478 case Instruction::Add:
6479 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006480 case Instruction::And:
6481 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006482 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006483 case Instruction::AShr:
6484 case Instruction::LShr:
6485 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006486 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006487 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
6488 Res = BinaryOperator::create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
6489 LHS, RHS, I->getName());
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006490 break;
6491 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006492 case Instruction::Trunc:
6493 case Instruction::ZExt:
6494 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006495 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006496 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
6497 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006498 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
6499 return I->getOperand(0);
6500
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006501 // Otherwise, must be the same type of case, so just reinsert a new one.
6502 Res = CastInst::create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
6503 Ty, I->getName());
6504 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006505 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006506 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6507 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
6508 break;
6509 }
6510
6511 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
6512}
6513
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006514/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
6515Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00006516 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6517
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00006518 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006519 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006520 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006521 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
6522 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
6523 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
6524 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
6525 return CastInst::create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00006526 }
6527 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00006528
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006529 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006530 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
6531 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
6532 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006533
6534 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00006535 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
6536 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
6537 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006538
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006539 return 0;
6540}
6541
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006542/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
6543Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
6544 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6545
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006546 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006547 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
6548 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006549 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
6550 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
6551 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
6552 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006553 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006554 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
6555 return &CI;
6556 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006557
6558 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
6559 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
6560 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
6561 // non-type-safe code.
6562 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
6563 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
6564 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
6565 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
6566 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
6567
6568 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
6569 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
6570 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
6571 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
6572 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
6573 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
6574
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006575 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
6576 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
6577 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006578 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006579 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00006580 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getABITypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006581 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
6582 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006583
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006584 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
6585 if (Offset < 0) {
6586 --FirstIdx;
6587 Offset += TySize;
6588 assert(Offset >= 0);
6589 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00006590 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006591 }
6592
6593 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006594
6595 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
6596 while (Offset) {
6597 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
6598 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006599 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
6600 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
6601 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006602
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006603 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
6604 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
6605 } else {
6606 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
6607 Offset = 0;
6608 OrigBase = 0;
6609 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006610 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
6611 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00006612 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getABITypeSize(STy->getElementType())){
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006613 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
6614 Offset %= EltSize;
6615 } else {
6616 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
6617 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006618 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
6619 } else {
6620 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
6621 Offset = 0;
6622 OrigBase = 0;
6623 }
6624 }
6625 if (OrigBase) {
6626 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
6627 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
6628 // two.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00006629 Instruction *NGEP = new GetElementPtrInst(OrigBase,
6630 NewIndices.begin(),
6631 NewIndices.end(), "");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006632 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
6633 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
6634
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006635 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
6636 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
6637 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
6638 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
6639 }
6640 }
6641 }
6642 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006643 }
6644
6645 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6646}
6647
6648
6649
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006650/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
6651/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006652/// cases.
6653/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
6654Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
6655 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
6656 return Result;
6657
6658 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6659 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
6660 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006661 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6662 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006663
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006664 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
6665 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006666 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
6667 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006668 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6669 return &CI;
6670
6671 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
6672 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006673 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
6674 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006675 return 0;
6676
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006677 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006678 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006679 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
6680 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006681 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006682 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006683 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
6684 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
6685 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
6686 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006687 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006688 bool DoXForm;
6689 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6690 default:
6691 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
6692 // get here because of the check above.
6693 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
6694 case Instruction::Trunc:
6695 DoXForm = true;
6696 break;
6697 case Instruction::ZExt:
6698 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
6699 break;
6700 case Instruction::SExt:
6701 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
6702 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006703 }
6704
6705 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006706 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
6707 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006708 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
6709 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6710 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
6711 case Instruction::Trunc:
6712 case Instruction::BitCast:
6713 // Just replace this cast with the result.
6714 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6715 case Instruction::ZExt: {
6716 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
6717 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00006718 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
6719 SrcBitSize));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006720 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Res, C);
6721 }
6722 case Instruction::SExt:
6723 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
6724 return CastInst::create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006725 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
6726 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006727 }
6728 }
6729 }
6730
6731 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
6732 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
6733
6734 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6735 case Instruction::Add:
6736 case Instruction::Mul:
6737 case Instruction::And:
6738 case Instruction::Or:
6739 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006740 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006741 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
6742 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6743 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6744 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
6745 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006746 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
6747 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00006748 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006749 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6750 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
6751 return BinaryOperator::create(
6752 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006753 }
6754 }
6755
6756 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
6757 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
6758 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006759 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006760 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006761 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006762 return BinaryOperator::createXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
6763 }
6764 break;
6765 case Instruction::SDiv:
6766 case Instruction::UDiv:
6767 case Instruction::SRem:
6768 case Instruction::URem:
6769 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
6770 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
6771 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6772 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6773 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006774 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
6775 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006776 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6777 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6778 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6779 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006780 return BinaryOperator::create(
6781 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
6782 }
6783 }
6784 break;
6785
6786 case Instruction::Shl:
6787 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
6788 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
6789 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
6790 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
6791 // in the value.
6792 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
6793 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006794 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
6795 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
6796 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006797 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006798 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006799 }
6800 break;
6801 case Instruction::AShr:
6802 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
6803 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
6804 // simplifications.
6805 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
6806 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006807 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006808 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
6809 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006810 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006811 }
6812 }
6813 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006814 }
6815 return 0;
6816}
6817
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006818Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006819 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6820 return Result;
6821
6822 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6823 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006824 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6825 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006826
6827 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
6828 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6829 default: break;
6830 case Instruction::LShr:
6831 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
6832 // are already zeros.
6833 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006834 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006835
6836 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006837 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006838 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
6839 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006840 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
6841 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
6842
6843 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
6844 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006845 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
6846 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
6847 Ty, CI);
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006848 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006849 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006850 } else { // This is a variable shr.
6851
6852 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
6853 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
6854 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006855 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006856 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
6857
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006858 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006859 BinaryOperator::createShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006860 "tmp"), CI);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006861 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(V,
6862 SrcI->getOperand(0),
6863 "tmp"), CI);
6864 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006865 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006866 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006867 }
6868 break;
6869 }
6870 }
6871
6872 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006873}
6874
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006875Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006876 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
6877 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6878 return Result;
6879
6880 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6881
6882 // If this is a cast of a cast
6883 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006884 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
6885 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
6886 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
6887 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
6888 // Get the sizes of the types involved
6889 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006890 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6891 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6892 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006893 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
6894 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
6895 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006896 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006897 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006898 Instruction *And =
6899 BinaryOperator::createAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
6900 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
6901 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
6902 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
6903 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006904 And = CastInst::createIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006905 }
6906 return And;
6907 }
6908 }
6909 }
6910
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00006911 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
6912 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
6913 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
6914 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
6915 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006916 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00006917
6918 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
6919 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
6920 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
6921 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
6922 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
6923 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
6924 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
6925 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createLShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006926 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00006927 CI);
6928 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
6929 In = CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
6930 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
6931
6932 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
6933 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
6934 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(In, One,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006935 In->getName()+".not"),
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00006936 CI);
6937 }
6938
6939 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6940 }
6941
6942
6943
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006944 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6945 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6946 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6947 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6948 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6949 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6950 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6951 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00006952 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
6953 // This only works for EQ and NE
6954 ICI->isEquality()) {
6955 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
6956 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
6957 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6958 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
6959 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
6960
6961 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
6962 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
6963 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6964 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
6965 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
6966 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
6967 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
6968 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
6969 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6970 }
6971
6972 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
6973 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
6974 if (ShiftAmt) {
6975 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
6976 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
6977 In = InsertNewInstBefore(
6978 BinaryOperator::createLShr(In,
6979 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
6980 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
6981 }
6982
6983 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
6984 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
6985 In = BinaryOperator::createXor(In, One, "tmp");
6986 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
6987 }
6988
6989 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
6990 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6991 else
6992 return CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
6993 }
6994 }
6995 }
6996 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006997 return 0;
6998}
6999
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007000Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007001 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7002 return I;
7003
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007004 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7005
7006 // sext (x <s 0) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
7007 // sext (x >s -1) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
7008 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
7009 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7010 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7011 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7012 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7013 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7014
7015 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
7016 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
7017 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7018 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
7019 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7020 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7021 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
7022 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007023 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007024 CI);
7025 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
7026 In = CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
7027 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7028
7029 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
7030 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(In,
7031 In->getName()+".not"), CI);
7032
7033 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7034 }
7035 }
7036 }
7037
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007038 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007039}
7040
7041Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI) {
7042 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7043}
7044
7045Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
7046 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7047}
7048
7049Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer44c030a2006-11-30 23:13:36 +00007050 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007051}
7052
7053Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer44c030a2006-11-30 23:13:36 +00007054 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007055}
7056
7057Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7058 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7059}
7060
7061Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7062 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7063}
7064
7065Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007066 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007067}
7068
7069Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI) {
7070 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7071}
7072
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007073Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007074 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
7075 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
7076 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7077 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7078 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
7079
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007080 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007081 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7082 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007083 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
7084 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
7085 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007086 } else {
7087 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7088 return Result;
7089 }
7090
7091
7092 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
7093 // be replaced by the operand.
7094 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
7095 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
7096
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007097 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007098 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
7099 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
7100 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
7101
7102 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
7103 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
7104 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
7105 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
7106 return V;
7107
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007108 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
7109 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007110 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
7111 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
7112 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
7113 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
7114 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
7115 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
7116 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
7117 ++NumZeros;
7118 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007119
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007120 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
7121 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
7122 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Chuck Rose IIIc331d302007-09-05 20:36:41 +00007123 return new GetElementPtrInst(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
7124 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007125 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007126 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00007127
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007128 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
7129 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
7130 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
7131 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007132 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
7133 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007134 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
7135 CastInst *Tmp;
7136 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
7137 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
7138 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
7139 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
7140 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
7141 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
7142 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007143 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7144 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
7145 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7146 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007147 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
7148 // know the vector types match #elts.
7149 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00007150 }
7151 }
7152 }
7153 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00007154 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00007155}
7156
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007157/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
7158/// %C = or %A, %B
7159/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
7160/// into:
7161/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
7162/// %D = or %A, %C
7163///
7164/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
7165/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
7166/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
7167///
7168static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
7169 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7170 case Instruction::Add:
7171 case Instruction::Mul:
7172 case Instruction::And:
7173 case Instruction::Or:
7174 case Instruction::Xor:
7175 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
7176 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
7177 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007178 case Instruction::LShr:
7179 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007180 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007181 default:
7182 return 0; // Cannot fold
7183 }
7184}
7185
7186/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
7187/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
7188static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
7189 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7190 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
7191 case Instruction::Add:
7192 case Instruction::Sub:
7193 case Instruction::Or:
7194 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007195 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007196 case Instruction::LShr:
7197 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007198 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007199 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00007200 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007201 case Instruction::Mul:
7202 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
7203 }
7204}
7205
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007206/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
7207/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
7208Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
7209 Instruction *FI) {
7210 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
7211 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
7212 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007213 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007214 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
7215 return 0;
7216 } else {
7217 return 0; // unknown unary op.
7218 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007219
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007220 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
7221 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
7222 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
7223 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007224 return CastInst::create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
7225 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007226 }
7227
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007228 // Only handle binary operators here.
7229 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007230 return 0;
7231
7232 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
7233 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
7234 bool MatchIsOpZero;
7235 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
7236 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
7237 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
7238 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
7239 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7240 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
7241 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
7242 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
7243 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
7244 MatchIsOpZero = false;
7245 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
7246 return 0;
7247 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
7248 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
7249 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
7250 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
7251 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7252 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
7253 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
7254 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
7255 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
7256 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7257 } else {
7258 return 0;
7259 }
7260
7261 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
7262 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
7263 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
7264 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
7265
7266 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
7267 if (MatchIsOpZero)
7268 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
7269 else
7270 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007271 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007272 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
7273 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007274}
7275
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007276Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007277 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
7278 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
7279 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
7280
7281 // select true, X, Y -> X
7282 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007283 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007284 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007285
7286 // select C, X, X -> X
7287 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
7288 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7289
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007290 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
7291 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7292 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
7293 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7294 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
7295 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
7296 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7297 else
7298 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7299 }
7300
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007301 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007302 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007303 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007304 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007305 return BinaryOperator::createOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007306 } else {
7307 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
7308 Value *NotCond =
7309 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
7310 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007311 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007312 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007313 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007314 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007315 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007316 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007317 } else {
7318 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
7319 Value *NotCond =
7320 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
7321 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007322 return BinaryOperator::createOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007323 }
7324 }
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007325 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007326
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007327 // Selecting between two integer constants?
7328 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
7329 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007330 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007331 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007332 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007333 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007334 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007335 Value *NotCond =
7336 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00007337 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007338 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00007339 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007340
7341 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007342
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007343 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007344
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007345 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007346 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007347 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007348 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007349 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007350 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007351 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007352 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007353 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
7354 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, X,
7355 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007356 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
7357
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007358 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
7359 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
7360 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007361 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7362 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007363 if (SRASize < SISize)
7364 opc = Instruction::SExt;
7365 else if (SRASize > SISize)
7366 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
7367 return CastInst::create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007368 }
7369 }
7370
7371
7372 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007373 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007374 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
7375 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007376 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00007377 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007378 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
7379 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
7380 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007381 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
7382 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
7383 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007384 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
7385 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007386 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
7387 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007388 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007389 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007390 Value *V = ICA;
7391 if (ShouldNotVal)
7392 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::create(
7393 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
7394 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
7395 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007396 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007397 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007398
7399 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007400 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
7401 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007402 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00007403 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
7404 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
7405 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
7406 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
7407 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
7408 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
7409 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
7410 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
7411 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007412 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00007413 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007414 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007415 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007416 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7417 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7418
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007419 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007420 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00007421 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
7422 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
7423 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
7424 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
7425 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
7426 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
7427 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
7428 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
7429 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
7430 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7431 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007432 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007433 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
7434 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7435 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7436 }
7437 }
7438
7439 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
7440 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal)) {
7441 if (ICI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
7442 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
7443 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
7444 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7445 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
7446 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
7447 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7448 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7449
7450 } else if (ICI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
7451 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
7452 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
7453 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7454 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
7455 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Chris Lattnerfbede522004-04-11 01:39:19 +00007456 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007457 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7458 }
7459 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007460
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007461 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
7462 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
7463 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007464 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
7465
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007466 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
7467 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
7468 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
7469 return IV;
7470
7471 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
7472 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007473 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
7474 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7475 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
7476 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
7477 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7478 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
7479 }
7480
7481 if (AddOp) {
7482 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
7483 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
7484 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
7485 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
7486 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
7487 }
7488
7489 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00007490 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
7491 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
7492 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
7493 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
7494 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
7495 } else {
7496 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
7497 BinaryOperator::createNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007498 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00007499
7500 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
7501 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
7502 if (AddOp != TI)
7503 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
7504 Instruction *NewSel =
7505 new SelectInst(CondVal, NewTrueOp,NewFalseOp,SI.getName()+".p");
7506
7507 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
7508 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007509 }
7510 }
7511 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007512
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007513 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007514 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007515 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
7516 // transformation we are doing here.
7517 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
7518 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7519 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
7520 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
7521 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7522 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
7523 OpToFold = 1;
7524 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
7525 OpToFold = 2;
7526 }
7527
7528 if (OpToFold) {
7529 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007530 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007531 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007532 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007533 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007534 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
7535 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007536 else {
7537 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
7538 }
7539 }
7540 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00007541
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007542 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
7543 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7544 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
7545 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
7546 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7547 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
7548 OpToFold = 1;
7549 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
7550 OpToFold = 2;
7551 }
7552
7553 if (OpToFold) {
7554 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007555 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007556 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), C, FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007557 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007558 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007559 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
7560 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007561 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007562 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007563 }
7564 }
7565 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00007566
7567 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
7568 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
7569 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
7570 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
7571 return &SI;
7572 }
7573
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007574 return 0;
7575}
7576
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007577/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
7578/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
7579/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
7580/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
7581static unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V, TargetData *TD,
7582 unsigned PrefAlign = 0) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007583 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V)) {
7584 unsigned Align = GV->getAlignment();
Andrew Lenharthb410df92007-11-08 18:45:15 +00007585 if (Align == 0 && TD && GV->getType()->getElementType()->isSized())
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007586 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(GV->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007587
7588 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
7589 // of the global.
7590 if (PrefAlign > Align && GV->hasInitializer()) {
7591 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
7592 Align = PrefAlign;
7593 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007594 return Align;
7595 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
7596 unsigned Align = AI->getAlignment();
7597 if (Align == 0 && TD) {
7598 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI))
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007599 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007600 else if (isa<MallocInst>(AI)) {
7601 // Malloc returns maximally aligned memory.
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007602 Align = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007603 Align =
7604 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007605 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::DoubleTy));
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007606 Align =
7607 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007608 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::Int64Ty));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007609 }
7610 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007611
7612 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
7613 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
7614 if (PrefAlign > Align && isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
7615 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
7616 Align = PrefAlign;
7617 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007618 return Align;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007619 } else if (isa<BitCastInst>(V) ||
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007620 (isa<ConstantExpr>(V) &&
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007621 cast<ConstantExpr>(V)->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007622 return GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(cast<User>(V)->getOperand(0),
7623 TD, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007624 } else if (User *GEPI = dyn_castGetElementPtr(V)) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007625 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
7626 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
7627 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
7628 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i)) ||
7629 !cast<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
7630 AllZeroOperands = false;
7631 break;
7632 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007633
7634 if (AllZeroOperands) {
7635 // Treat this like a bitcast.
7636 return GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(GEPI->getOperand(0), TD, PrefAlign);
7637 }
7638
7639 unsigned BaseAlignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(GEPI->getOperand(0),TD);
7640 if (BaseAlignment == 0) return 0;
7641
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007642 // Otherwise, if the base alignment is >= the alignment we expect for the
7643 // base pointer type, then we know that the resultant pointer is aligned at
7644 // least as much as its type requires.
7645 if (!TD) return 0;
7646
7647 const Type *BasePtrTy = GEPI->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007648 const PointerType *PtrTy = cast<PointerType>(BasePtrTy);
Lauro Ramos Venancioc7d11142007-07-31 20:13:21 +00007649 unsigned Align = TD->getABITypeAlignment(PtrTy->getElementType());
7650 if (Align <= BaseAlignment) {
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007651 const Type *GEPTy = GEPI->getType();
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007652 const PointerType *GEPPtrTy = cast<PointerType>(GEPTy);
Lauro Ramos Venancioc7d11142007-07-31 20:13:21 +00007653 Align = std::min(Align, (unsigned)
7654 TD->getABITypeAlignment(GEPPtrTy->getElementType()));
7655 return Align;
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007656 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007657 return 0;
7658 }
7659 return 0;
7660}
7661
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007662
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007663/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
7664/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
7665/// the heavy lifting.
7666///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007667Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007668 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
7669 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
7670
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007671 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
7672 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007673 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007674 bool Changed = false;
7675
7676 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
7677 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
7678 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7679
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007680 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007681 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007682 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
7683 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
7684 // alignment is sufficient.
7685 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007686 }
7687
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007688 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
7689 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
7690 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007691 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007692 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
7693 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
7694 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007695 const char *Name;
Andrew Lenharth8ed4c472006-11-03 22:45:50 +00007696 if (CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType()->getParamType(2) ==
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007697 Type::Int32Ty)
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007698 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i32";
7699 else
7700 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i64";
Chris Lattner92141962007-01-07 06:58:05 +00007701 Constant *MemCpy = M->getOrInsertFunction(Name,
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007702 CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType());
7703 CI.setOperand(0, MemCpy);
7704 Changed = true;
7705 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007706 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007707
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007708 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
7709 // set, update the alignment.
7710 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007711 unsigned Alignment1 = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1), TD);
7712 unsigned Alignment2 = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2), TD);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007713 unsigned Align = std::min(Alignment1, Alignment2);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007714 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Align) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007715 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Align));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007716 Changed = true;
7717 }
Devang Patelf9193de2007-10-11 17:21:57 +00007718
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007719 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
7720 // load/store.
Devang Patelf9193de2007-10-11 17:21:57 +00007721 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CI.getOperand(3));
Devang Patel7b9e1d22007-10-12 20:10:21 +00007722 if (MemOpLength) {
Devang Patelf9193de2007-10-11 17:21:57 +00007723 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
7724 unsigned Align = cast<ConstantInt>(CI.getOperand(4))->getZExtValue();
Devang Patelf9193de2007-10-11 17:21:57 +00007725 PointerType *NewPtrTy = NULL;
Devang Patel7b9e1d22007-10-12 20:10:21 +00007726 // Destination pointer type is always i8 *
Devang Patelb9e98132007-10-15 15:31:35 +00007727 // If Size is 8 then use Int64Ty
7728 // If Size is 4 then use Int32Ty
7729 // If Size is 2 then use Int16Ty
7730 // If Size is 1 then use Int8Ty
7731 if (Size && Size <=8 && !(Size&(Size-1)))
Devang Patelafc407e2007-10-17 07:24:40 +00007732 NewPtrTy = PointerType::get(IntegerType::get(Size<<3));
Devang Patelb9e98132007-10-15 15:31:35 +00007733
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007734 if (NewPtrTy) {
Chris Lattnerbde90f02007-11-06 01:15:27 +00007735 Value *Src = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, CI.getOperand(2),
7736 NewPtrTy, CI);
7737 Value *Dest = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, CI.getOperand(1),
7738 NewPtrTy, CI);
Devang Patelafc407e2007-10-17 07:24:40 +00007739 Value *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, Align, &CI);
Devang Patelf9193de2007-10-11 17:21:57 +00007740 Value *NS = new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, Align, &CI);
7741 CI.replaceAllUsesWith(NS);
7742 Changed = true;
7743 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7744 }
7745 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007746 } else if (isa<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007747 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest(), TD);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007748 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007749 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007750 Changed = true;
7751 }
7752 }
7753
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007754 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007755 } else {
7756 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
7757 default: break;
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007758 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
7759 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007760 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
7761 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
7762 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
7763 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
7764 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007765 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD, 16) >= 16) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007766 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007767 PointerType::get(II->getType()), CI);
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007768 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
7769 }
7770 break;
7771 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
7772 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
7773 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007774 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), TD, 16) >= 16) {
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007775 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007776 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(2),
7777 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007778 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
7779 }
7780 break;
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007781 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
7782 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
7783 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
7784 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storel_dq:
7785 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007786 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD, 16) >= 16) {
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007787 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007788 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
7789 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007790 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
7791 }
7792 break;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007793
7794 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
7795 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
7796 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
7797 uint64_t UndefElts;
7798 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
7799 UndefElts)) {
7800 II->setOperand(1, V);
7801 return II;
7802 }
7803 break;
7804 }
7805
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007806 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
7807 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007808 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007809 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
7810
7811 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
7812 bool AllEltsOk = true;
7813 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7814 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
7815 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
7816 AllEltsOk = false;
7817 break;
7818 }
7819 }
7820
7821 if (AllEltsOk) {
7822 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007823 Value *Op0 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7824 II->getOperand(1), Mask->getType(), CI);
7825 Value *Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7826 II->getOperand(2), Mask->getType(), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007827 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
7828
7829 // Only extract each element once.
7830 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
7831 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
7832
7833 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7834 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
7835 continue;
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007836 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007837 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
7838
7839 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
7840 Instruction *Elt =
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007841 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007842 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
7843 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
7844 }
7845
7846 // Insert this value into the result vector.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007847 Result = new InsertElementInst(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx], i,"tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007848 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
7849 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007850 return CastInst::create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007851 }
7852 }
7853 break;
7854
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007855 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
7856 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
7857 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
7858 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
7859 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
7860 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
7861 if (&*++BI == II)
7862 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7863 }
7864 }
7865
7866 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
7867 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
7868 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
7869 if (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)) {
7870 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
7871 bool CannotRemove = false;
7872 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
7873 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI) ||
7874 (isa<CallInst>(BI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BI))) {
7875 CannotRemove = true;
7876 break;
7877 }
7878 }
7879 if (!CannotRemove)
7880 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7881 }
7882 break;
7883 }
7884 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007885 }
7886
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007887 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007888}
7889
7890// InvokeInst simplification
7891//
7892Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007893 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007894}
7895
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007896// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
7897//
7898Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007899 bool Changed = false;
7900
7901 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
7902 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007903 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
7904
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007905 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007906
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007907 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
7908 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
7909 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
7910 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
7911 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007912 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007913 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007914 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
7915 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
7916 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
7917 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
7918 return 0;
7919 }
7920
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007921 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
7922 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
7923 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
7924 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007925 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007926 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007927 CS.getInstruction());
7928
7929 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
7930 CS.getInstruction()->
7931 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
7932
7933 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
7934 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
7935 new BranchInst(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007936 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007937 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007938 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
7939 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007940
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00007941 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
7942 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
7943 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
7944 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
7945
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007946 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
7947 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
7948 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
7949 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
7950 // the call.
7951 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
7952 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I)
7953 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I)) {
7954 // If this cast does not effect the value passed through the varargs
7955 // area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
7956 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007957 if (CI->isLosslessCast()) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007958 *I = Op;
7959 Changed = true;
7960 }
7961 }
7962 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007963
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007964 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007965}
7966
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007967// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
7968// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
7969//
7970bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
7971 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
7972 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007973 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
7974 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007975 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00007976 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007977 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
7978
7979 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
7980 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
7981 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
7982 //
7983 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
7984 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
7985
Chris Lattnera2b18de2007-05-19 06:51:32 +00007986 const FunctionType *ActualFT =
7987 cast<FunctionType>(cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType());
7988
7989 // If the parameter attributes don't match up, don't do the xform. We don't
7990 // want to lose an sret attribute or something.
7991 if (FT->getParamAttrs() != ActualFT->getParamAttrs())
7992 return false;
7993
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007994 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
7995 if (OldRetTy != FT->getReturnType()) {
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007996 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !Caller->use_empty() &&
Chris Lattner46013f42007-01-06 19:53:32 +00007997 // Conversion is ok if changing from pointer to int of same size.
7998 !(isa<PointerType>(FT->getReturnType()) &&
7999 TD->getIntPtrType() == OldRetTy))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00008000 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008001
8002 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
8003 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
8004 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
8005 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
8006 if (!Caller->use_empty())
8007 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
8008 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
8009 UI != E; ++UI)
8010 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
8011 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00008012 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008013 return false;
8014 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008015
8016 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
8017 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008018
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008019 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
8020 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
8021 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00008022 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008023 ConstantInt *c = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(*AI);
Dale Johannesen16ff3042007-04-04 19:16:42 +00008024 //Some conversions are safe even if we do not have a body.
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00008025 //Either we can cast directly, or we can upconvert the argument
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00008026 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Chris Lattner46013f42007-01-06 19:53:32 +00008027 (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) && isa<PointerType>(ActTy)) ||
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008028 (ParamTy->isInteger() && ActTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00008029 ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ||
8030 (c && ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00008031 && c->getValue().isStrictlyPositive());
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008032 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Dale Johannesen16ff3042007-04-04 19:16:42 +00008033
8034 // Most other conversions can be done if we have a body, even if these
8035 // lose information, e.g. int->short.
8036 // Some conversions cannot be done at all, e.g. float to pointer.
8037 // Logic here parallels CastInst::getCastOpcode (the design there
8038 // requires legality checks like this be done before calling it).
8039 if (ParamTy->isInteger()) {
8040 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
8041 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
8042 return false;
8043 }
8044 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !ActTy->isFloatingPoint() &&
8045 !isa<PointerType>(ActTy))
8046 return false;
8047 } else if (ParamTy->isFloatingPoint()) {
8048 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
8049 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
8050 return false;
8051 }
8052 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !ActTy->isFloatingPoint())
8053 return false;
8054 } else if (const VectorType *VParamTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ParamTy)) {
8055 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
8056 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != VParamTy->getBitWidth())
8057 return false;
8058 }
8059 if (VParamTy->getBitWidth() != ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
8060 return false;
8061 } else if (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy)) {
8062 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(ActTy))
8063 return false;
8064 } else {
8065 return false;
8066 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008067 }
8068
8069 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008070 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008071 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body...
8072
8073 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
8074 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
8075 std::vector<Value*> Args;
8076 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
8077
8078 AI = CS.arg_begin();
8079 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
8080 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
8081 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
8082 Args.push_back(*AI);
8083 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008084 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008085 false, ParamTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008086 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008087 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008088 }
8089 }
8090
8091 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
8092 // now...
8093 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
8094 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
8095
8096 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
8097 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs)
8098 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00008099 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
8100 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008101 } else {
8102 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
8103 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
8104 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
8105 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
8106 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008107 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
8108 PTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008109 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008110 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
8111 Args.push_back(Cast);
8112 } else {
8113 Args.push_back(*AI);
8114 }
8115 }
8116 }
8117
8118 if (FT->getReturnType() == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008119 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008120
8121 Instruction *NC;
8122 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00008123 NC = new InvokeInst(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
David Greenef1355a52007-08-27 19:04:21 +00008124 Args.begin(), Args.end(), Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00008125 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008126 } else {
Chris Lattner684b22d2007-08-02 16:53:43 +00008127 NC = new CallInst(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
8128 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00008129 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
8130 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Chris Lattnere4370262005-05-14 12:25:32 +00008131 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008132 }
8133
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008134 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008135 Value *NV = NC;
8136 if (Caller->getType() != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
8137 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008138 const Type *CallerTy = Caller->getType();
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008139 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
8140 CallerTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008141 NV = NC = CastInst::create(opcode, NC, CallerTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00008142
8143 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
8144 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
8145 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
8146 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->begin();
8147 while (isa<PHINode>(I)) ++I;
8148 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
8149 } else {
8150 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
8151 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
8152 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008153 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008154 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00008155 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008156 }
8157 }
8158
8159 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
8160 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00008161 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008162 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008163 return true;
8164}
8165
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00008166// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
8167// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
8168//
8169Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
8170 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
8171 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
8172 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
8173
8174 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
8175 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
8176
8177 Function *NestF =
8178 cast<Function>(IntrinsicInst::StripPointerCasts(Tramp->getOperand(2)));
8179 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
8180 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
8181
8182 if (const ParamAttrsList *NestAttrs = NestFTy->getParamAttrs()) {
8183 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
8184 const Type *NestTy = 0;
8185 uint16_t NestAttr = 0;
8186
8187 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
8188 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
8189 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
8190 if (NestAttrs->paramHasAttr(NestIdx, ParamAttr::Nest)) {
8191 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
8192 NestTy = *I;
8193 NestAttr = NestAttrs->getParamAttrs(NestIdx);
8194 break;
8195 }
8196
8197 if (NestTy) {
8198 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
8199 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
8200 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
8201
8202 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
8203 // mean appending it.
8204 {
8205 unsigned Idx = 1;
8206 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
8207 do {
8208 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
8209 // Add the chain argument.
8210 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
8211 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
8212 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
8213 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
8214 }
8215
8216 if (I == E)
8217 break;
8218
8219 // Add the original argument.
8220 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
8221
8222 ++Idx, ++I;
8223 } while (1);
8224 }
8225
8226 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
8227 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
8228 // with the chain parameter inserted. Likewise for attributes.
8229
8230 const ParamAttrsList *Attrs = FTy->getParamAttrs();
8231 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
8232 ParamAttrsVector NewAttrs;
8233 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
8234
8235 // Add any function result attributes.
8236 uint16_t Attr = Attrs ? Attrs->getParamAttrs(0) : 0;
8237 if (Attr)
8238 NewAttrs.push_back (ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
8239
8240 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
8241 // mean appending it. Likewise for the chain's attributes.
8242 {
8243 unsigned Idx = 1;
8244 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
8245 E = FTy->param_end();
8246
8247 do {
8248 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
8249 // Add the chain's type and attributes.
8250 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
8251 NewAttrs.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
8252 }
8253
8254 if (I == E)
8255 break;
8256
8257 // Add the original type and attributes.
8258 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
8259 Attr = Attrs ? Attrs->getParamAttrs(Idx) : 0;
8260 if (Attr)
8261 NewAttrs.push_back
8262 (ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
8263
8264 ++Idx, ++I;
8265 } while (1);
8266 }
8267
8268 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
8269 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
8270 FunctionType *NewFTy =
8271 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg(),
8272 ParamAttrsList::get(NewAttrs));
8273 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::get(NewFTy) ?
8274 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::get(NewFTy));
8275
8276 Instruction *NewCaller;
8277 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
8278 NewCaller = new InvokeInst(NewCallee,
8279 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
8280 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
8281 Caller->getName(), Caller);
8282 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
8283 } else {
8284 NewCaller = new CallInst(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
8285 Caller->getName(), Caller);
8286 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
8287 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
8288 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
8289 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
8290 }
8291 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
8292 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
8293 Caller->eraseFromParent();
8294 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
8295 return 0;
8296 }
8297 }
8298
8299 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
8300 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
8301 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
8302 Constant *NewCallee =
8303 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
8304 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
8305 return CS.getInstruction();
8306}
8307
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008308/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
8309/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
8310/// and a single binop.
8311Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
8312 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008313 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
8314 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008315 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008316 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
8317 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
8318
8319 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
8320 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008321
8322 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
8323 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00008324 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008325 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00008326 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008327 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008328 // types or GEP's with different index types.
8329 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
8330 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008331 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008332
8333 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
8334 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
8335 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
8336 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
8337 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008338
8339 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
8340 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
8341 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008342 }
8343
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008344 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
8345
8346 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
8347 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
8348 // hide them behind a phi.
8349 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
8350 return 0;
8351
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008352 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008353 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008354 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008355 if (LHSVal == 0) {
8356 NewLHS = new PHINode(LHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName()+".pn");
8357 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
8358 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008359 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
8360 LHSVal = NewLHS;
8361 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008362
8363 if (RHSVal == 0) {
8364 NewRHS = new PHINode(RHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName()+".pn");
8365 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
8366 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008367 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
8368 RHSVal = NewRHS;
8369 }
8370
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008371 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
8372 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8373 if (NewLHS) {
8374 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
8375 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8376 }
8377 if (NewRHS) {
8378 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
8379 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8380 }
8381 }
8382
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008383 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008384 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008385 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
8386 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
8387 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008388 else {
8389 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
8390 return new GetElementPtrInst(LHSVal, RHSVal);
8391 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008392}
8393
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008394/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
8395/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
8396/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
8397/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00008398///
8399/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
8400/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
8401/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008402static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
8403 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
8404
8405 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
8406 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
8407 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00008408
8409 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
8410 // profitable to do this xform.
8411 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
8412 bool isAddressTaken = false;
8413 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
8414 UI != E; ++UI) {
8415 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
8416 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
8417 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
8418 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
8419 }
8420 isAddressTaken = true;
8421 break;
8422 }
8423
8424 if (!isAddressTaken)
8425 return false;
8426 }
8427
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008428 return true;
8429}
8430
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008431
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008432// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
8433// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
8434// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
8435Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
8436 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
8437
8438 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
8439 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
8440 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
8441 // code size and simplifying code.
8442 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
8443 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008444 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008445 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
8446 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008447 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008448 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
8449 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008450 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008451 if (ConstantOp == 0)
8452 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008453 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
8454 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
8455 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
8456 // load and the PHI.
8457 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
8458 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
8459 return 0;
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008460 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008461 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008462 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
8463 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
8464 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008465 } else {
8466 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
8467 }
8468
8469 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
8470 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8471 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
8472 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008473 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008474 return 0;
8475 if (CastSrcTy) {
8476 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
8477 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008478 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008479 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
8480 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008481 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
8482 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
8483 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
8484 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008485 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
8486 return 0;
8487 }
8488 }
8489
8490 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
8491 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
8492 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
8493 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00008494 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008495
8496 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
8497 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008498
8499 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008500 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8501 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
8502 if (NewInVal != InVal)
8503 InVal = 0;
8504 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8505 }
8506
8507 Value *PhiVal;
8508 if (InVal) {
8509 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
8510 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
8511 PhiVal = InVal;
8512 delete NewPN;
8513 } else {
8514 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
8515 PhiVal = NewPN;
8516 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008517
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008518 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008519 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
8520 return CastInst::create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008521 else if (isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008522 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008523 else if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008524 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008525 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
8526 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
8527 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008528 else
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008529 assert(0 && "Unknown operation");
Jeff Cohenca5183d2007-03-05 00:00:42 +00008530 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008531}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008532
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008533/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
8534/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008535static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
8536 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008537 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
8538 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
8539
8540 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008541 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008542 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +00008543
8544 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
8545 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
8546 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008547
8548 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
8549 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008550
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008551 return false;
8552}
8553
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00008554/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
8555/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
8556/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
8557static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
8558 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
8559 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
8560 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
8561 return true;
8562
8563 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
8564 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
8565 return false;
8566
8567 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
8568 // the value.
8569 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8570 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
8571 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
8572 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
8573 return false;
8574 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
8575 return false;
8576 }
8577
8578 return true;
8579}
8580
8581
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00008582// PHINode simplification
8583//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008584Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +00008585 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +00008586 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +00008587
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008588 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
8589 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
8590
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008591 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
8592 // reducing code size.
8593 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
8594 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
8595 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
8596 return Result;
8597
8598 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
8599 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
8600 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00008601 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
8602 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
8603 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008604 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008605 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
8606 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
8607 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
8608 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00008609
8610 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
8611 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
8612 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
8613 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
8614 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
8615 // late.
8616 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
8617 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
8618 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
8619 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
8620 }
8621 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008622
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00008623 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
8624 // same value, for example:
8625 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
8626 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
8627 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
8628 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
8629 {
8630 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
8631 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
8632 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
8633 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
8634 ++InValNo;
8635
8636 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
8637 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
8638
8639 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
8640 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
8641 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
8642 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
8643 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
8644 break;
8645 }
8646
8647 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
8648 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
8649 // the value.
8650 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
8651 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
8652 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
8653 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
8654 }
8655 }
8656 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +00008657 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00008658}
8659
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008660static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
8661 Instruction *InsertPoint,
8662 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00008663 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8664 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008665 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
8666 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
8667 // used for address computation.
8668 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
8669 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
8670 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
8671 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008672}
8673
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008674
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008675Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008676 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008677 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008678 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008679 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008680 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008681
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008682 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
8683 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
8684
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008685 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
8686 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
8687 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
8688
8689 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008690 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008691
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008692 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
8693 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008694
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008695 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008696 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008697 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
8698 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(GEP.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00008699 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
8700 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
8701 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
8702 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
8703 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
8704 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
8705 MadeChange = true;
8706 GEP.setOperand(i, CI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008707 }
8708 }
8709 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008710 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
8711 // to what we need. If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
8712 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
8713 // obvious.
8714 Value *Op = GEP.getOperand(i);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00008715 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits())
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00008716 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008717 GEP.setOperand(i, ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00008718 MadeChange = true;
8719 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008720 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
8721 GEP);
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008722 GEP.setOperand(i, Op);
8723 MadeChange = true;
8724 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008725 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008726 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008727 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
8728
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008729 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
8730 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
8731 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00008732 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices()) {
8733 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))) {
8734 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
8735 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
8736 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
8737 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +00008738 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
8739 if (I != BCI) {
8740 I->takeName(BCI);
8741 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
8742 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
8743 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00008744 return &GEP;
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +00008745 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00008746 }
8747 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
8748 }
8749 }
8750
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008751 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
8752 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
8753 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
8754 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008755 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00008756 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008757 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00008758
8759 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008760 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
8761 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
8762 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
8763 //
8764 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
8765 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
8766 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
8767
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008768 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008769
8770 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
8771 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
8772 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
8773 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +00008774 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008775
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008776 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008777 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +00008778 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
8779 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
8780 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008781 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008782 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
8783 Sum = GO1;
8784 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
8785 Sum = SO1;
8786 } else {
8787 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
8788 // target's pointer size.
8789 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
8790 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008791 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008792 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008793 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008794 } else {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00008795 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
8796 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008797 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008798 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008799
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00008800 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008801 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008802 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008803 } else {
8804 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008805 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
8806 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008807 }
8808 }
8809 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008810 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
8811 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
8812 else {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00008813 Sum = BinaryOperator::createAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
8814 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008815 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008816 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008817
8818 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
8819 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
8820 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
8821 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
8822 return &GEP;
8823 } else {
8824 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8825 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
8826 Indices.push_back(Sum);
8827 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
8828 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008829 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008830 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008831 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008832 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00008833 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8834 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008835 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
8836 }
8837
8838 if (!Indices.empty())
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008839 return new GetElementPtrInst(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
8840 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008841
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008842 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008843 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
8844 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
8845
8846 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008847 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008848 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
8849 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
8850 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
8851
8852 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008853 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
8854 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008855
8856 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
8857 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
8858 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008859 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008860 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
8861 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
8862 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
8863 // transform: GEP (cast [10 x ubyte]* X to [0 x ubyte]*), long 0, ...
8864 // into : GEP [10 x ubyte]* X, long 0, ...
8865 //
8866 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
8867 //
8868 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
8869 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
8870 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
8871 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
8872 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
8873 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
8874 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
8875 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
8876 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
8877 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
8878 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
8879 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
8880 return &GEP;
8881 }
8882 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
8883 // Transform things like:
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008884 // %t = getelementptr ubyte* cast ([2 x int]* %str to uint*), uint %V
8885 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x int*]* %str, int 0, uint %V; cast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008886 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
8887 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
8888 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00008889 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
8890 TD->getABITypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008891 Value *Idx[2];
8892 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8893 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008894 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008895 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008896 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
8897 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008898 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008899
8900 // Transform things like:
8901 // getelementptr sbyte* cast ([100 x double]* X to sbyte*), int %tmp
8902 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
8903 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, int 0, int %tmp.2
8904
8905 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008906 (ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty || ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty)) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008907 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00008908 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008909
8910 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
8911 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
8912 Value *NewIdx = 0;
8913 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
8914 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
8915 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
8916 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
8917 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +00008918 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008919 Scale = CI;
8920 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
8921 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
8922 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00008923 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
8924 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
8925 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008926 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
8927 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
8928 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
8929 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
8930 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
8931 }
8932 }
8933
8934 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
8935 // out, perform the transformation.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008936 if (Scale && Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008937 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Scale))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008938 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
8939 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
8940 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008941 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
8942 true /*SExt*/);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008943 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::createMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
8944 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
8945 }
8946
8947 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008948 Value *Idx[2];
8949 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8950 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008951 Instruction *NewGEP =
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008952 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008953 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
8954 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
8955 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008956 }
8957 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008958 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008959 }
8960
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008961 return 0;
8962}
8963
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008964Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
8965 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
8966 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008967 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
8968 const Type *NewTy =
8969 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008970 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008971
8972 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
8973 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00008974 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008975 else {
8976 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00008977 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008978 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008979
8980 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008981
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008982 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
8983 // allocas if possible...
8984 //
8985 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
8986 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
8987
8988 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
8989 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
8990 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008991 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008992 Value *Idx[2];
8993 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
8994 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
8995 Value *V = new GetElementPtrInst(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
Chris Lattner693787a2005-05-04 19:10:26 +00008996 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008997
8998 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
8999 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009000 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009001 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
9002 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009003 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009004
9005 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
9006 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
9007 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009008 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009009 TD->getABITypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009010 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
9011
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009012 return 0;
9013}
9014
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00009015Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
9016 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
9017
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009018 // free undef -> unreachable.
9019 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
9020 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009021 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00009022 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009023 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
9024 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +00009025
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +00009026 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
9027 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009028 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009029 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +00009030
9031 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
9032 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
9033 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
9034 return &FI;
9035 }
9036
9037 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
9038 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
9039 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
9040 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
9041 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
9042 return &FI;
9043 }
9044 }
9045
9046 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
9047 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
9048 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
9049 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
9050 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
9051 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +00009052
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00009053 return 0;
9054}
9055
9056
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009057/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +00009058static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
9059 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00009060 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00009061 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00009062
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +00009063 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
9064 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
9065 // directly if string length is small enough.
9066 const std::string &Str = CE->getOperand(0)->getStringValue();
9067 if (!Str.empty()) {
9068 unsigned len = Str.length();
9069 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
9070 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
9071 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
9072 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
9073 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
9074 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
9075 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
9076 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
9077 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
9078 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
9079 }
9080 } else {
9081 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
9082 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
9083 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
9084 }
9085 // Append NULL at the end.
9086 SingleChar = 0;
9087 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
9088 }
9089 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(StrVal);
9090 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
9091 }
9092 }
9093 }
9094
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00009095 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00009096 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00009097 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00009098
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00009099 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009100 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00009101 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
9102 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
9103 // constants.
9104 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
9105 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
9106 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00009107 Value *Idxs[2];
9108 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9109 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00009110 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
9111 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
9112 }
9113
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00009114 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009115 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +00009116 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
9117 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
9118 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00009119 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
9120 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009121
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00009122 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
9123 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
9124 // the result of the loaded value.
9125 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
9126 CI->getName(),
9127 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
9128 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00009129 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00009130 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00009131 }
9132 }
9133 return 0;
9134}
9135
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009136/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00009137/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
9138/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
9139/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
9140static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +00009141 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
9142 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
9143
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +00009144 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +00009145 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +00009146 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +00009147 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00009148
9149 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
9150 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00009151 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
9152 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
9153 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00009154 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
9155
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00009156 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00009157 --BBI;
9158
9159 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
9160 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
9161 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
9162 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009163
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00009164 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00009165 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009166}
9167
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +00009168/// GetUnderlyingObject - Trace through a series of getelementptrs and bitcasts
9169/// until we find the underlying object a pointer is referring to or something
9170/// we don't understand. Note that the returned pointer may be offset from the
9171/// input, because we ignore GEP indices.
9172static Value *GetUnderlyingObject(Value *Ptr) {
9173 while (1) {
9174 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr)) {
9175 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast ||
9176 CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
9177 Ptr = CE->getOperand(0);
9178 else
9179 return Ptr;
9180 } else if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Ptr)) {
9181 Ptr = BCI->getOperand(0);
9182 } else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
9183 Ptr = GEP->getOperand(0);
9184 } else {
9185 return Ptr;
9186 }
9187 }
9188}
9189
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00009190Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
9191 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +00009192
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00009193 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009194 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op, TD);
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00009195 if (KnownAlign > LI.getAlignment())
9196 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
9197
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009198 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00009199 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +00009200 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009201 return Res;
9202
9203 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
9204 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00009205
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00009206 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
9207 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +00009208 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
9209 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00009210 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
9211 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
9212 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +00009213 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
9214 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
9215 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00009216 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009217
9218 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op))
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00009219 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009220 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
9221 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
9222 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
9223 // CFG.
9224 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
9225 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
9226 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
9227 }
9228
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009229 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009230 // load null/undef -> undef
9231 if ((C->isNullValue() || isa<UndefValue>(C))) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009232 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
9233 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
9234 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009235 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
9236 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009237 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009238 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00009239
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009240 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
9241 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009242 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009243 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009244
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009245 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
9246 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op))
9247 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
9248 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009249 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +00009250 if (Constant *V =
9251 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009252 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009253 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
9254 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
9255 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
9256 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
9257 // CFG.
9258 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
9259 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
9260 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
9261 }
9262
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009263 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +00009264 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009265 return Res;
9266 }
9267 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +00009268
9269 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
9270 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
9271 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(GetUnderlyingObject(Op))) {
9272 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
9273 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
9274 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
9275 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
9276 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
9277 }
9278 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +00009279
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009280 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009281 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
9282 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
9283 // exposes redundancy in the code.
9284 //
9285 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
9286 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
9287 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
9288 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
9289 // unconditionally.
9290 //
9291 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
9292 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00009293 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
9294 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009295 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +00009296 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009297 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +00009298 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009299 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
9300 }
9301
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +00009302 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
9303 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
9304 if (C->isNullValue()) {
9305 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
9306 return &LI;
9307 }
9308
9309 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
9310 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
9311 if (C->isNullValue()) {
9312 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
9313 return &LI;
9314 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009315 }
9316 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00009317 return 0;
9318}
9319
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +00009320/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009321/// when possible.
9322static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
9323 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
9324 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
9325
9326 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
9327 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
9328 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
9329
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00009330 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009331 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
9332 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
9333 // constants.
9334 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
9335 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
9336 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00009337 Value* Idxs[2];
9338 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9339 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009340 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
9341 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
9342 }
9343
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +00009344 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
9345 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
9346 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009347
9348 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00009349 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
9350 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009351 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00009352 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00009353 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
9354 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
9355 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
9356 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
9357 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00009358 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +00009359 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00009360 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00009361 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
9362 }
9363 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00009364 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009365 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009366 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00009367 CastInst::create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
9368 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009369 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
9370 }
9371 }
9372 }
9373 return 0;
9374}
9375
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009376Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
9377 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
9378 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
9379
9380 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009381 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009382 ++NumCombined;
9383 return 0;
9384 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +00009385
9386 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
9387 // alloca dead.
9388 if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
9389 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
9390 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9391 ++NumCombined;
9392 return 0;
9393 }
9394
9395 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
9396 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
9397 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
9398 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9399 ++NumCombined;
9400 return 0;
9401 }
9402 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009403
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00009404 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009405 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr, TD);
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00009406 if (KnownAlign > SI.getAlignment())
9407 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
9408
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009409 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
9410 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
9411 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
9412 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
9413 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
9414 --ScanInsts) {
9415 --BBI;
9416
9417 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
9418 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
9419 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
9420 ++NumDeadStore;
9421 ++BBI;
9422 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
9423 continue;
9424 }
9425 break;
9426 }
9427
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +00009428 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
9429 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
9430 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
9431 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattnera54c7eb2007-09-07 05:33:03 +00009432 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +00009433 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9434 ++NumCombined;
9435 return 0;
9436 }
9437 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
9438 // may not be dead.
9439 break;
9440 }
9441
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009442 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +00009443 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009444 break;
9445 }
9446
9447
9448 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009449
9450 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
9451 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
9452 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
9453 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
9454 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009455 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009456 ++NumCombined;
9457 }
9458 return 0; // Do not modify these!
9459 }
9460
9461 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
9462 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009463 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009464 ++NumCombined;
9465 return 0;
9466 }
9467
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009468 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
9469 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00009470 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009471 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
9472 return Res;
9473 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009474 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009475 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
9476 return Res;
9477
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009478
9479 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
9480 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009481 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009482 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009483 if (BI->isUnconditional())
9484 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
9485 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009486
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009487 return 0;
9488}
9489
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009490/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
9491/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
9492/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
9493///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009494/// Simplify things like:
9495/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
9496/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
9497///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009498bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
9499 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
9500
9501 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
9502 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
9503 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009504 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009505
9506 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
9507 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009508 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
9509 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009510 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009511 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009512 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009513 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009514 return false;
9515
9516 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009517 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009518 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009519 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009520 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009521 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009522 return false;
9523
9524
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009525 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
9526 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009527 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009528 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009529 return false;
9530
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009531 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
9532 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
9533 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
9534 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
9535 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
9536 --BBI;
9537 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
9538 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
9539 return false;
9540 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009541 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009542 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
9543 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
9544 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
9545 return false;
9546
9547 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009548 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
9549 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009550 for (;; --BBI) {
9551 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
9552 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
9553 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
9554 return false;
9555 break;
9556 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009557 // If we find something that may be using the stored value, or if we run
9558 // out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009559 if (isa<LoadInst>(BBI) || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
9560 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
9561 return false;
9562 }
9563
9564 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
9565 // make sure nothing reads the stored value in StoreBB.
9566 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
9567 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
9568 if (isa<LoadInst>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory())
9569 return false;
9570 }
9571 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009572
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009573 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009574 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
9575 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
9576 PHINode *PN = new PHINode(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
9577 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
9578 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009579 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
9580 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009581 }
9582
9583 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
9584 // insert it.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009585 BBI = DestBB->begin();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009586 while (isa<PHINode>(BBI)) ++BBI;
9587 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
9588 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
9589
9590 // Nuke the old stores.
9591 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9592 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
9593 ++NumCombined;
9594 return true;
9595}
9596
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009597
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +00009598Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
9599 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00009600 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00009601 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
9602 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
9603 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
9604 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
9605 // Swap Destinations and condition...
9606 BI.setCondition(X);
9607 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9608 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
9609 return &BI;
9610 }
9611
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009612 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
9613 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
9614 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
9615 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
9616 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
9617 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
9618 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009619 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009620 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
9621 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009622 // Swap Destinations and condition...
9623 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
9624 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9625 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009626 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009627 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009628 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009629 return &BI;
9630 }
9631
9632 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
9633 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
9634 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
9635 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
9636 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
9637 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
9638 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
9639 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009640 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009641 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
9642 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009643 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00009644 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009645 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9646 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009647 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009648 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009649 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009650 return &BI;
9651 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009652
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +00009653 return 0;
9654}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009655
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009656Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
9657 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
9658 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
9659 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
9660 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
9661 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
9662 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009663 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009664 AddRHS));
9665 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009666 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009667 return &SI;
9668 }
9669 }
9670 return 0;
9671}
9672
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009673/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
9674/// is to leave as a vector operation.
9675static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
9676 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
9677 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009678 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009679 if (isConstant) return true;
9680 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
9681 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
9682 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
9683 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
9684 return false;
9685 return true;
9686 }
9687 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
9688 if (!I) return false;
9689
9690 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
9691 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
9692 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
9693 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
9694 return true;
9695 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
9696 return true;
9697 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
9698 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
9699 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
9700 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
9701 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009702 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
9703 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
9704 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
9705 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
9706 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009707
9708 return false;
9709}
9710
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00009711/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
9712///
9713/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
9714/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009715static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
9716 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
9717 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
9718 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
9719 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
9720 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
9721
9722 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009723 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009724 for (unsigned i = 0, e = CP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
9725 if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i)))
9726 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
9727 else
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009728 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(CP->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009729 return Result;
9730}
9731
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009732/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
9733/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
9734/// extracted from the vector.
9735static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009736 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
9737 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009738 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
9739 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009740 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
9741
9742 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
9743 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
9744 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
9745 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009746 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009747 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
9748 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9749 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009750 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
9751 return 0;
9752 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009753
9754 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
9755 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009756 if (EltNo == IIElt)
9757 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009758
9759 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
9760 // vector input.
9761 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009762 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009763 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
9764 if (InEl < Width)
9765 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
9766 else if (InEl < Width*2)
9767 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
9768 else
9769 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009770 }
9771
9772 // Otherwise, we don't know.
9773 return 0;
9774}
9775
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009776Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009777
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009778 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +00009779 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
9780 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
9781
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009782 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +00009783 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
9784 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
9785
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009786 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009787 // If vector val is constant with uniform operands, replace EI
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009788 // with that operand
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009789 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009790 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009791 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
9792 op0 = 0;
9793 break;
9794 }
9795 if (op0)
9796 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009797 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009798
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009799 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
9800 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009801 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +00009802 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
9803 unsigned VectorWidth =
9804 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
9805
9806 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
9807 // crashing the code below.
9808 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
9809 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
9810
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009811 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
9812 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
9813 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +00009814 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009815 uint64_t UndefElts;
9816 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009817 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009818 UndefElts)) {
9819 EI.setOperand(0, V);
9820 return &EI;
9821 }
9822 }
9823
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009824 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009825 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +00009826
9827 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
9828 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
9829 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
9830 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
9831 if (const VectorType *VT =
9832 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
9833 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
9834 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
9835 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
9836 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009837 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009838
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009839 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009840 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
9841 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
9842 // profitable to do so
9843 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009844 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
9845 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
9846 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
9847 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
9848 EI.getName()+".lhs");
9849 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
9850 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
9851 EI.getName()+".rhs");
9852 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
9853 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
9854 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
9855 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00009856 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009857 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, I->getOperand(0),
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009858 PointerType::get(EI.getType()), EI);
9859 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
Reid Spencerde331242006-11-29 01:11:01 +00009860 new GetElementPtrInst(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName() + ".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009861 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
9862 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009863 }
9864 }
9865 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
9866 // Extracting the inserted element?
9867 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
9868 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
9869 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
9870 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
9871 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
9872 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
9873 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
9874 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
9875 return &EI;
9876 }
9877 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
9878 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
9879 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009880 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
9881 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009882 Value *Src;
9883 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
9884 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
9885 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
9886 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
9887 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
9888 } else {
9889 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +00009890 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009891 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009892 }
9893 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009894 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009895 return 0;
9896}
9897
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009898/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
9899/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
9900/// Otherwise, return false.
9901static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
9902 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
9903 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
9904 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009905 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009906
9907 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009908 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009909 return true;
9910 } else if (V == LHS) {
9911 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009912 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009913 return true;
9914 } else if (V == RHS) {
9915 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009916 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009917 return true;
9918 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9919 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
9920 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
9921 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
9922 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
9923
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009924 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
9925 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009926 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009927
9928 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
9929 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
9930 // transitively ok.
9931 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
9932 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009933 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009934 return true;
9935 }
9936 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
9937 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009938 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
9939 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009940 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009941
9942 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
9943 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
9944 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
9945 // transitively ok.
9946 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
9947 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
9948 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
9949 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009950 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009951 } else {
9952 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
9953 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009954 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009955
9956 }
9957 return true;
9958 }
9959 }
9960 }
9961 }
9962 }
9963 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
9964
9965 return false;
9966}
9967
9968/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
9969/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
9970/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009971static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009972 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009973 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009974 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009975 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009976 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009977
9978 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009979 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009980 return V;
9981 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009982 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009983 return V;
9984 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9985 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
9986 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
9987 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
9988 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
9989
9990 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
9991 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
9992 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
9993 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009994 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
9995 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009996
9997 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
9998 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009999 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
10000 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
10001 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010002 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010003 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010004 return V;
10005 }
10006
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010007 if (VecOp == RHS) {
10008 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010009 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
10010 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
10011 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010012 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010013 }
10014 return V;
10015 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010016
10017 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
10018 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
10019 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
10020 return EI->getOperand(0);
10021
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010022 }
10023 }
10024 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010025 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010026
10027 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
10028 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010029 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010030 return V;
10031}
10032
10033Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
10034 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
10035 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
10036 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
10037
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000010038 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
10039 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
10040 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
10041
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010042 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
10043 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
10044 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
10045 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
10046 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
10047 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000010048 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
10049 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010050 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010051
10052 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
10053 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
10054
10055 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
10056 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
10057
10058 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
10059 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
10060 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
10061 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
10062
10063 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
10064 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
10065 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
10066 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
10067 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
10068 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
10069 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
10070 // Build a new shuffle mask.
10071 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
10072 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010073 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010074 else {
10075 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010076 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010077 NumVectorElts));
10078 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010079 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010080 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010081 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010082 }
10083
10084 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
10085 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
10086 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
10087 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010088 Value *RHS = 0;
10089 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
10090 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
10091 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010092 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010093 }
10094 }
10095 }
10096
10097 return 0;
10098}
10099
10100
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010101Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
10102 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
10103 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010104 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010105
10106 bool MadeChange = false;
10107
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010108 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010109 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010110 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
10111
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000010112 // If we have shuffle(x, undef, mask) and any elements of mask refer to
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010113 // the undef, change them to undefs.
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000010114 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(1))) {
10115 // Scan to see if there are any references to the RHS. If so, replace them
10116 // with undef element refs and set MadeChange to true.
10117 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
10118 if (Mask[i] >= e && Mask[i] != 2*e) {
10119 Mask[i] = 2*e;
10120 MadeChange = true;
10121 }
10122 }
10123
10124 if (MadeChange) {
10125 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
10126 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
10127 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
10128 if (Mask[i] == 2*e)
10129 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
10130 else
10131 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
10132 }
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010133 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000010134 }
10135 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010136
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010137 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
10138 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
10139 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
10140 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010141 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
10142 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
10143 }
10144
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010145 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
10146 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
10147 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010148 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010149 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010150 else {
10151 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
10152 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS)))
10153 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
10154 else
10155 Mask[i] &= (e-1); // Force to LHS.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010156 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010157 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010158 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010159 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010160 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010161 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010162 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
10163 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010164 MadeChange = true;
10165 }
10166
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010167 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010168 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000010169
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010170 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
10171 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
10172 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
10173 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
10174
10175 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
10176 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000010177 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010178
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010179 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
10180 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
10181 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010182
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010183 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
10184 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
10185 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
10186 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
10187 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
10188 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
10189 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
10190 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
10191 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
10192 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
10193 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
10194 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
10195
10196 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
10197 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
10198 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
10199 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
10200 else
10201 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
10202
10203 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
10204 // the replacement.
10205 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
10206 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
10207 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
10208 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010209 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010210 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010211 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010212 }
10213 }
10214 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
10215 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010216 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010217 }
10218 }
10219 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000010220
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010221 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
10222}
10223
10224
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010225
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010226
10227/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
10228/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
10229/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
10230/// end of its block.
10231static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
10232 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
10233
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000010234 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
10235 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory()) return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010236
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010237 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000010238 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
10239 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010240 return false;
10241
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000010242 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
10243 // the end of block that could change the value.
10244 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000010245 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = LI, E = LI->getParent()->end();
10246 Scan != E; ++Scan)
10247 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
10248 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000010249 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010250
10251 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->begin();
10252 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) ++InsertPos;
10253
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000010254 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010255 ++NumSunkInst;
10256 return true;
10257}
10258
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010259
10260/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
10261/// all reachable code to the worklist.
10262///
10263/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
10264/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
10265/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
10266/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
10267/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
10268///
10269static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000010270 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010271 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010272 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010273 std::vector<BasicBlock*> Worklist;
10274 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010275
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010276 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
10277 BB = Worklist.back();
10278 Worklist.pop_back();
10279
10280 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
10281 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
10282
10283 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
10284 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010285
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010286 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
10287 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
10288 ++NumDeadInst;
10289 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
10290 Inst->eraseFromParent();
10291 continue;
10292 }
10293
10294 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
10295 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
10296 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
10297 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
10298 ++NumConstProp;
10299 Inst->eraseFromParent();
10300 continue;
10301 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000010302
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010303 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010304 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010305
10306 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
10307 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
10308 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
10309 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
10310 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
10311 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
10312 Worklist.push_back(BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal));
10313 continue;
10314 }
10315 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
10316 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
10317 // See if this is an explicit destination.
10318 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
10319 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
10320 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(i));
10321 continue;
10322 }
10323
10324 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
10325 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
10326 continue;
10327 }
10328 }
10329
10330 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
10331 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010332 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010333}
10334
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010335bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010336 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000010337 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010338
10339 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
10340 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010341
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000010342 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010343 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
10344 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
10345 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000010346 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010347 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000010348
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000010349 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
10350 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
10351 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
10352 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
10353 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
10354 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
10355 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
10356 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000010357
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010358 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000010359 ++NumDeadInst;
10360
10361 if (!I->use_empty())
10362 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
10363 I->eraseFromParent();
10364 }
10365 }
10366 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010367
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010368 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
10369 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
10370 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010371
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010372 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010373 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010374 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010375 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010376 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010377 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010378
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010379 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000010380
10381 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010382 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010383 continue;
10384 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010385
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010386 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000010387 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010388 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000010389
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010390 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010391 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000010392 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
10393
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010394 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010395 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010396 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010397 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010398 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010399
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010400 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
10401 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
10402 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
10403 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
10404 if (UserParent != BB) {
10405 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
10406 // See if the user is one of our successors.
10407 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
10408 if (*SI == UserParent) {
10409 UserIsSuccessor = true;
10410 break;
10411 }
10412
10413 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
10414 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
10415 // otherwise), we can keep going.
10416 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
10417 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
10418 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
10419 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
10420 }
10421 }
10422
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010423 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000010424#ifndef NDEBUG
10425 std::string OrigI;
10426#endif
10427 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010428 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000010429 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010430 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000010431 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010432 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
10433 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000010434
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010435 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
10436 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
10437
10438 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010439 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010440 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010441
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010442 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
10443 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010444
10445 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
10446 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010447 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
10448
10449 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
10450 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
10451 ++InsertPos;
10452
10453 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010454
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010455 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
10456 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010457 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000010458
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010459 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
10460 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010461 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010462
10463 // Erase the old instruction.
10464 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010465 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000010466#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000010467 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
10468 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000010469#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000010470
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010471 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
10472 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010473 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
10474 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
10475 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010476 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010477
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010478 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010479 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010480 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010481 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010482 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010483 AddToWorkList(I);
10484 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010485 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000010486 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010487 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010488 }
10489 }
10490
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010491 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000010492
10493 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
10494 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010495 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000010496}
10497
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010498
10499bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010500 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
10501
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010502 bool EverMadeChange = false;
10503
10504 // Iterate while there is work to do.
10505 unsigned Iteration = 0;
10506 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
10507 EverMadeChange = true;
10508 return EverMadeChange;
10509}
10510
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000010511FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010512 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000010513}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000010514